jtag: add -ir-bypass option to newtap
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2022 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A
34 copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free
35 Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
83 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
84 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
85 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
86 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
87
88 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
89 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
90 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
91 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
92 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
93 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
94 @end menu
95
96 @node About
97 @unnumbered About
98 @cindex about
99
100 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
101 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
102 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
103 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
104 around the world.
105
106 @section What is OpenOCD?
107 @cindex TAP
108 @cindex JTAG
109
110 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
111 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
112 devices.
113
114 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
115 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
116 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
117 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
118 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
119 needed to hook up to the target.
120
121 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
122 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
123 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
124 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
125 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
126
127 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
128 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
129 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
130 let the development board connect directly to the debug
131 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
132
133 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
134 signaling, and is used to communicate
135 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
136 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
137 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
138 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
139 scan operations.
140
141 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
142 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
143 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
144 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
145
146 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
147 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
148 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
149 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
150
151
152 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
153 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
154 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
155
156 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
157 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
158 (Stellaris LM3, STMicroelectronics STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and
159 Intel Quark (x10xx) based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
160
161 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
162 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
163 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
164 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
165 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
166
167 @section OpenOCD Web Site
168
169 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
170
171 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
172
173 @section Latest User's Guide:
174
175 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
176 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
177 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
178
179 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
180
181 PDF form is likewise published at:
182
183 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
184
185 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
186
187 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
188 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
189 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
190 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
191 instead of this forum.
192
193 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
194
195 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
196
197 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
198 communication between users:
199
200 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
201
202 @section OpenOCD IRC
203
204 Support can also be found on irc:
205 @uref{irc://irc.libera.chat/openocd}
206
207 @node Developers
208 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
209 @cindex developers
210
211 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
212 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
213 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
214 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
215
216 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
217 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
218
219 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
220
221 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
222 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
223
224 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
225
226 or via http
227
228 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
229
230 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
231
232 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
233
234 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
235 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
236 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
237 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
238 needing a Git client:
239
240 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
241
242 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
243 from the repository or a snapshot.
244
245 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
246 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
247 Patches created against older versions may require additional
248 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
249
250 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
251
252 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
253 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
254 technical information about the software internals, development
255 processes, and similar documentation:
256
257 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
258
259 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
260 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
261 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
262
263 @section Gerrit Review System
264
265 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
266 Code Review System:
267
268 @uref{https://review.openocd.org/}
269
270 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
271 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
272 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
273 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
274 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
275
276 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
277 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
278 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
279 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
280 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
281
282 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
283
284 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
285 communication between developers:
286
287 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
288
289 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
290
291 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
292
293 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
294
295
296 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
297 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @cindex dongles
299 @cindex FTDI
300 @cindex wiggler
301 @cindex printer port
302 @cindex USB Adapter
303 @cindex RTCK
304
305 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
306 an adapter .... [snip]
307
308 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
309 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port.
310
311
312 @section Choosing a Dongle
313
314 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
315
316 @enumerate
317 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
318 OpenOCD focuses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
319 other ways to communicate with target devices.
320 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
321 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
322 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
323 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
324 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
325 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
326 Ethernet port needed?
327 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
328 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
329 @end enumerate
330
331 @section USB FT2232 Based
332
333 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
334 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
335 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
336 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
337 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
338 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
339 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
340 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
341 clocking.)
342
343 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
344 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
345 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
346 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
347 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
348
349 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
350 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
351
352 @itemize @bullet
353 @item @b{usbjtag}
354 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
355 @item @b{jtagkey}
356 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
357 @item @b{jtagkey2}
358 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
359 @item @b{oocdlink}
360 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
361 @item @b{signalyzer}
362 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
363 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
364 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
365 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
366 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
367 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
368 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
369 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
370 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
371 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
372 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
373 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
374 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
375 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
376 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
377 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
378 @item @b{turtelizer2}
379 @* See:
380 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
381 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
382 @item @b{comstick}
383 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
384 @item @b{stm32stick}
385 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
386 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
387 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
388 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
389 @item @b{cortino}
390 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
391 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
392 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
393 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
394 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
395 @item @b{opendous}
396 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
397 (OpenHardware).
398 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
399 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
400
401 @item @b{GW16042}
402 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
403 FT2232H-based
404
405 @end itemize
406 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
407
408 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
409 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
410 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
411 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
412 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
413
414 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
415 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
416 (see the section on driver commands).
417
418 @itemize
419 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
420 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
421 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
422 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
423 @end itemize
424
425 @section USB J-Link based
426 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
427 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
428 AT91SAM764 internally.
429
430 @itemize @bullet
431 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
432 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
433 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
434 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
435 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
436 @end itemize
437
438 @section USB RLINK based
439 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
440 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
441 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
442
443 @itemize @bullet
444 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
445 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
446 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
447 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
448 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB ST-LINK based
453 STMicroelectronics has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
454 They only work with STMicroelectronics chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
455
456 @itemize @bullet
457 @item @b{ST-LINK}
458 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
460 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
461 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
462 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
463 @item @b{STLINK-V3}
464 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits.
465 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/stlink-v3}
466 @item @b{STLINK-V3PWR}
467 @* This is available standalone.
468 Beside the debugger functionality, the probe includes a SMU (source
469 measurement unit) aimed at analyzing power consumption during code
470 execution. The SMU is not supported by OpenOCD.
471 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/stlink-v3pwr}
472 @end itemize
473
474 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
475 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
476 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
477 @itemize @bullet
478 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
479 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
480 @end itemize
481
482 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
483 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
484 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
485 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
486
487 @section USB Nuvoton Nu-Link
488 Nuvoton has an adapter called @b{Nu-Link}.
489 It is available either as stand-alone dongle and embedded on development boards.
490 It supports SWD, serial port bridge and mass storage for firmware update.
491 Both Nu-Link v1 and v2 are supported.
492
493 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
494 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
495 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
496
497 @section USB Other
498 @itemize @bullet
499 @item @b{USBprog}
500 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
501
502 @item @b{USB - Presto}
503 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
504
505 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
506 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
507
508 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
509 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
510
511 @item @b{angie}
512 @* Link: @url{https://nanoxplore.org/}
513
514 @item @b{Buspirate}
515 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
516
517 @item @b{opendous}
518 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
519
520 @item @b{estick}
521 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
522
523 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
524 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
525
526 @item @b{TI XDS110 Debug Probe}
527 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds110.html}
528 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds_software_package_download.html#xds110-support-utilities}
529 @end itemize
530
531 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
532
533 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
534 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
535 these on the market.
536
537 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
538 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
539 of USB-based ones.
540
541 @itemize @bullet
542
543 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
544 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
545
546 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
547 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
548 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
549
550 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
551 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
552
553 @item @b{Wiggler2}
554 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
555
556 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
557 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
558
559 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
560 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
561
562 @item @b{arm-jtag}
563 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
564
565 @item @b{chameleon}
566 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
567
568 @item @b{Triton}
569 @* Unknown.
570
571 @item @b{Lattice}
572 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
573 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
574
575 @item @b{flashlink}
576 @* From STMicroelectronics;
577 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
578
579 @end itemize
580
581 @section Other...
582 @itemize @bullet
583
584 @item @b{ep93xx}
585 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
586
587 @item @b{at91rm9200}
588 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
589
590 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
591 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
592
593 @item @b{imx_gpio}
594 @* A NXP i.MX-based board (e.g. Wandboard) using the GPIO pins (should work on any i.MX processor).
595
596 @item @b{am335xgpio}
597 @* A Texas Instruments AM335x-based board (e.g. BeagleBone Black) using the GPIO pins of the expansion headers.
598
599 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
600 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
601 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
602
603 @item @b{vdebug}
604 @* A driver for Cadence virtual Debug Interface to emulated or simulated targets.
605 It implements a client connecting to the vdebug server, which in turn communicates
606 with the emulated or simulated RTL model through a transactor. The driver supports
607 JTAG and DAP-level transports.
608
609 @item @b{jtag_dpi}
610 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the SystemVerilog Direct Programming
611 Interface (DPI) for JTAG devices. DPI allows OpenOCD to connect to the JTAG
612 interface of a hardware model written in SystemVerilog, for example, on an
613 emulation model of target hardware.
614
615 @item @b{xlnx_pcie_xvc}
616 @* A JTAG driver exposing Xilinx Virtual Cable over PCI Express to OpenOCD as JTAG/SWD interface.
617
618 @item @b{linuxgpiod}
619 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux GPIO through library libgpiod.
620
621 @item @b{sysfsgpio}
622 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux legacy sysfs GPIO.
623 This is deprecated from Linux v5.3; prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}.
624
625 @item @b{esp_usb_jtag}
626 @* A JTAG driver to communicate with builtin debug modules of Espressif ESP32-C3 and ESP32-S3 chips using OpenOCD.
627
628 @end itemize
629
630 @node About Jim-Tcl
631 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
632 @cindex Jim-Tcl
633 @cindex tcl
634
635 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
636 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
637 command interpreter.
638
639 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
640 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
641 much of anything about Tcl.
642 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
643
644 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
645 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
646 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
647 OpenOCD mailing list.
648
649 @itemize @bullet
650 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
651 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
652 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
653 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
654 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
655 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
656
657 @item @b{Missing Features}
658 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
659 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
660 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
661 enabled in OpenOCD.
662
663 @item @b{Scripts}
664 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
665 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
666 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
667
668 @item @b{Commands}
669 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
670 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
671 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
672 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
673
674 @item @b{Historical Note}
675 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
676 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
677 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
678 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
679
680 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
681 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
682 @end itemize
683
684 @node Running
685 @chapter Running
686 @cindex command line options
687 @cindex logfile
688 @cindex directory search
689
690 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
691 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
692 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
693 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
694 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
695 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
696 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
697
698 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
699 tell it how each debug session should work.
700 The @option{--help} option shows:
701 @verbatim
702 bash$ openocd --help
703
704 --help | -h display this help
705 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
706 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
707 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
708 --debug | -d set debug level to 3
709 | -d<n> set debug level to <level>
710 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
711 --command | -c run <command>
712 @end verbatim
713
714 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
715 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
716 To specify one or more different
717 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
718
719 @example
720 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
721 @end example
722
723 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
724 @enumerate
725 @item the current directory,
726 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
727 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
728 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
729 @item @file{%APPDATA%/OpenOCD} (only on Windows),
730 @item @file{$HOME/Library/Preferences/org.openocd} (only on Darwin),
731 @item @file{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME/openocd} (@env{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME} defaults to @file{$HOME/.config}),
732 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd},
733 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
734 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
735 @end enumerate
736 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
737
738 @quotation Note
739 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
740 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
741 @end quotation
742
743 @section Simple setup, no customization
744
745 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
746 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
747 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
748 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
749 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
750
751 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
752 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
753 the server with some variation of one of the following:
754
755 @example
756 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
757 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
758 @end example
759
760 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
761 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
762 If all goes well you'll see output something like
763
764 @example
765 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
766 For bug reports, read
767 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
768 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
769 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
770 @end example
771
772 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
773 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
774 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
775
776 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
777
778 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
779 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
780 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
781 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
782 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
783 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
784 ensure that this always succeeds.
785 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
786 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
787 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
788 and then shut down without acting as a server.
789
790 Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
791 clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
792 those channels.
793
794 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
795 the @option{-d} option.
796
797 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
798 @option{-c} command line switch.
799
800 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
801 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
802 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
803 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
804 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
805 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
806 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
807
808 You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
809 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
810
811 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
812 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
813 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
814 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
815
816 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
817 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
818
819 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
820 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
821 and start the OpenOCD server.
822 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
823 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
824 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
825 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
826
827 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
828
829 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
830 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
831 and a USB cable on the other.
832 Instead of USB, some dongles use Ethernet;
833 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
834
835 @enumerate
836 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
837 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
838 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
839 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
840 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
841 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
842 debugging host.
843
844 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
845 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
846 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
847 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
848 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
849
850 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
851 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
852 with 1.2 Volt boards.
853
854 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
855 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
856 ways to connect the cable.
857 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
858 Be sure it's firmly connected.
859
860 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
861 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
862 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
863 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
864 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
865 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
866 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
867 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
868
869 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
870 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
871 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
872 but are tedious to set up.
873 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
874 adapter signals to the right board pins.
875
876 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
877 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
878 you are using to run OpenOCD.
879 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
880
881 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
882 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
883 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
884 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
885
886 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
887 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
888 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
889
890 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
891 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
892 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
893 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
894
895 @end enumerate
896
897 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
898 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
899 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
900
901 @section Project Directory
902
903 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
904
905 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
906 single directory for your work with a given board.
907 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
908 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
909 files accessed through semihosting,
910 and for code you upload to the target board.
911 It is also the natural place to write files,
912 such as log files and data you download from the board.
913
914 @section Configuration Basics
915
916 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
917 a variety of ways you can mix them.
918 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
919
920 @itemize
921 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
922 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
923 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
924 @end itemize
925
926 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
927 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
928 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
929
930 @example
931 source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
932
933 # GDB can also flash my flash!
934 gdb_memory_map enable
935 gdb_flash_program enable
936
937 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
938 @end example
939
940 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
941
942 @example
943 openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
944 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
945 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
946 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
947 @end example
948
949 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
950 each supporting a different development task.
951 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
952 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
953
954 @quotation Important
955 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
956 problems with how it treats variables.
957 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
958 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
959 that can be tested in a later script.
960 @end quotation
961
962 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
963 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
964 to simplify your work.
965
966 @section User Config Files
967 @cindex config file, user
968 @cindex user config file
969 @cindex config file, overview
970
971 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
972 in one place.
973 One of the following will match your situation best:
974
975 @itemize
976 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
977 provided by someone else.
978 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
979 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
980 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
981 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
982 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
983 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
984
985 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
986 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
987
988 @enumerate
989 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
990 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
991 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
992 @end enumerate
993
994 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
995 The first is an interface config file.
996 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
997 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
998 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
999 meet your deadline:
1000
1001 @example
1002 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
1003 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
1004 @end example
1005
1006 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
1007 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
1008 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
1009 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
1010
1011 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
1012 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
1013 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
1014 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
1015 target and board
1016 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
1017 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
1018
1019 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
1020 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
1021 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
1022 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
1023
1024 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
1025 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
1026 giving access to your particular flash chips.
1027 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
1028 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
1029
1030 @quotation Note
1031 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1032 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1033 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1034 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1035 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1036 @end quotation
1037
1038 @item
1039 You may need to write some C code.
1040 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1041 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1042 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1043 a new chip architecture.
1044 @end itemize
1045
1046 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1047 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1048 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1049
1050 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1051 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1052 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1053 @itemize
1054
1055 @item
1056 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1057 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1058 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1059 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1060
1061 @item
1062 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1063 @cindex vector_catch
1064 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1065 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a time-saver
1066 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1067 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1068 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1069 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1070
1071 @item
1072 You might need to override some defaults.
1073 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1074 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1075
1076 @item
1077 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1078 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1079 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1080 @end itemize
1081
1082 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1083
1084 A few project-specific utility
1085 routines may well speed up your work.
1086 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1087
1088 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1089 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1090 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1091 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1092 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1093 may help:
1094
1095 @example
1096 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1097 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1098 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1099 # Leave the CPU halted.
1100 reset init
1101
1102 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1103 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1104
1105 # Start running.
1106 resume 0x20000000
1107 @}
1108 @end example
1109
1110 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1111 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1112 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1113 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1114 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1115
1116 @example
1117 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1118 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1119 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1120 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1121 reset init
1122
1123 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1124 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1125 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1126 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1127 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1128 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1129 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1130
1131 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1132 reset run
1133 @}
1134 @end example
1135
1136 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1137 from NAND.
1138 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1139 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1140 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1141
1142 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1143 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1144
1145 @section Target Software Changes
1146
1147 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1148 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1149 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1150 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1151 handling issues like:
1152
1153 @itemize @bullet
1154
1155 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1156 Watchdog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1157 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1158 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1159 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1160 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1161 your debug sessions.
1162
1163 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1164 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1165 That might however be your only option.
1166
1167 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1168 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1169 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1170 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1171 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1172 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1173 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1174 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1175 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1176 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1177 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1178 instead of the whole thing.
1179 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1180 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1181
1182 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1183 @cindex ARM semihosting
1184 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1185 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1186 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1187 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1188 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1189 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1190 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1191 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1192 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1193 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1194 NAND or SPI flash.
1195
1196 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1197 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1198 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1199 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1200 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1201
1202 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1203 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1204 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1205 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1206 registers which can be used to change various features including
1207 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1208 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1209 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1210 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1211 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1212
1213 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1214 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1215 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1216 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1217 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1218
1219 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1220 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1221 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1222 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1223 early code execution can be debugged
1224 or firmware can be replaced.
1225
1226 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1227 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1228 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1229 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1230 operations like writing to memory.)
1231
1232 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1233 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1234 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1235 various kinds of message.
1236 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1237
1238 @end itemize
1239
1240 @section Target Hardware Setup
1241
1242 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1243 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1244 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1245 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1246 working with.}
1247
1248 Common issues include:
1249
1250 @itemize @bullet
1251
1252 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1253 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1254 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1255 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1256 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1257 or one from a daughtercard).
1258 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1259 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1260
1261 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1262 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1263 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1264 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1265 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1266 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1267
1268 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1269 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1270 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1271 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1272 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1273
1274
1275 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1276 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1277 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1278 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1279 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1280 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1281 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1282
1283 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1284 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1285 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1286 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1287 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1288
1289 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1290 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1291 used to start booting.
1292
1293 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1294 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1295 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1296 multiple audio codec chips).
1297 This interacts with software
1298 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1299 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1300 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1301 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1302 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1303 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1304 audio or video codecs are used.
1305
1306 @end itemize
1307
1308 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1309 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1310 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1311 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1312 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1313 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1314 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1315 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1316 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1317 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1318
1319
1320 @node Config File Guidelines
1321 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1322
1323 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1324 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1325 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1326 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1327
1328 You should find the following directories under
1329 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1330 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1331 @itemize @bullet
1332 @item @file{interface} ...
1333 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1334 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1335 @item @file{board} ...
1336 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1337 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1338
1339 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1340 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1341 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1342 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1343 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1344 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1345 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1346 a CPU and an FPGA.
1347 @item @file{target} ...
1348 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1349 on a chip
1350 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1351 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1352 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1353 the target config file defines all of them.
1354 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1355 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1356 @end itemize
1357
1358 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1359 file may override features in any of the above files by
1360 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1361 commands specific to their situation.
1362
1363 @section Interface Config Files
1364
1365 The user config file
1366 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1367
1368 @example
1369 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1370 @end example
1371
1372 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1373 in use today with OpenOCD.
1374 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1375 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1376
1377 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1378 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1379 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1380 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1381 and need to provide a driver for it.
1382
1383 @deffn {Command} {find} 'filename'
1384 Prints full path to @var{filename} according to OpenOCD search rules.
1385 @end deffn
1386
1387 @deffn {Command} {ocd_find} 'filename'
1388 Prints full path to @var{filename} according to OpenOCD search rules. This
1389 is a low level function used by the @command{find}. Usually you want
1390 to use @command{find}, instead.
1391 @end deffn
1392
1393 @section Board Config Files
1394 @cindex config file, board
1395 @cindex board config file
1396
1397 The user config file
1398 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1399
1400 @example
1401 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1402 @end example
1403
1404 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1405 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1406 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1407
1408 @enumerate
1409 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1410 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1411 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1412 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1413 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1414 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1415 @end enumerate
1416
1417 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1418 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1419 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1420 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1421
1422 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1423 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1424 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1425 configuration works.
1426
1427 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1428
1429 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1430 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1431 convention on how to use certain variables.
1432
1433 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1434 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1435 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1436 used at will within a target configuration file.
1437
1438 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1439 for a board with three chips:
1440
1441 @example
1442 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1443 set CHIPNAME network
1444 set ENDIAN big
1445 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1446 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1447 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1448 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1449
1450 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1451 set CHIPNAME video
1452 set ENDIAN little
1453 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1454 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1455 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1456 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1457
1458 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1459 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1460 unset ENDIAN
1461 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1462 @end example
1463
1464 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1465 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1466 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1467 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1468 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1469 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1470 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1471 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1472
1473 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1474 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1475 naming collisions.
1476
1477 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1478 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1479 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1480 up other clocks and peripherals.
1481
1482 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1483 @cindex variable names
1484
1485 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1486 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1487 one such chip (as shown above).
1488 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1489 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1490 to promote consistency and
1491 so that board files can override target defaults.
1492
1493 Inputs to target config files include:
1494
1495 @itemize @bullet
1496 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1497 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1498 tap identifier dotted names.
1499 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1500 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1501 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1502 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1503 Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
1504 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1505 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1506 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1507 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1508 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1509 @end itemize
1510
1511 Outputs from target config files include:
1512
1513 @itemize @bullet
1514 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1515 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1516 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1517 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1518 specific to that board and that target.
1519 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1520 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1521 @end itemize
1522
1523 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1524 @cindex event, reset-init
1525 @cindex reset-init handler
1526
1527 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1528 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1529 fully set up yet.
1530 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1531 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1532 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1533 handler is one of the most important.
1534
1535 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1536 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1537 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1538 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1539 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1540
1541 @quotation Note
1542 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1543 are included here.
1544 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1545 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1546 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1547 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1548 @end quotation
1549
1550 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1551 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1552 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1553 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1554 those as parameters.
1555 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1556 and disabling the watchdog.
1557 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1558 the next developer doing such work.
1559 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1560
1561 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1562 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1563 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1564 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1565
1566 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1567
1568 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1569 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1570 a low JTAG clock rate.
1571 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1572 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1573 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1574 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1575 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1576 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1577 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1578
1579 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1580 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1581 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1582 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1583 which might be less than that.
1584
1585 @quotation Warning
1586 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1587 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1588 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1589 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1590 @end quotation
1591
1592 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1593 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1594 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1595 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter speed}.
1596 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1597 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1598
1599 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1600 @subsection The init_board procedure
1601 @cindex init_board procedure
1602
1603 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1604 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1605 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1606 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1607 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1608 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1609 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1610 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1611 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1612 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1613 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1614 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1615
1616 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1617 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1618
1619 @example
1620 ### board_file.cfg ###
1621
1622 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1623 source [find target/target.cfg]
1624
1625 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1626 # enables fast on-board clock source
1627 # configures the chip to use it
1628 @}
1629
1630 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1631 proc init_board @{@} @{
1632 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1633
1634 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-start @{
1635 adapter speed 100
1636 @}
1637
1638 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1639 enable_fast_clock
1640 adapter speed 10000
1641 @}
1642 @}
1643 @end example
1644
1645 @section Target Config Files
1646 @cindex config file, target
1647 @cindex target config file
1648
1649 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1650 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1651 more target config files like this:
1652
1653 @example
1654 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1655 @end example
1656
1657 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1658 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1659 In summary the target files should contain
1660
1661 @enumerate
1662 @item Set defaults
1663 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1664 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1665 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1666 @item On-Chip flash
1667 @end enumerate
1668
1669 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1670 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1671 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1672
1673 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1674 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1675 can talk to the chip.
1676 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1677 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1678 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1679 and other processing engines.
1680
1681 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1682
1683 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1684 letting board config files express environment-specific
1685 differences in how things should be set up.
1686
1687 @example
1688 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1689 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1690 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1691 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1692 @} else @{
1693 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1694 @}
1695
1696 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1697 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1698 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1699 @} else @{
1700 set _ENDIAN little
1701 @}
1702
1703 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1704 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1705 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1706 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1707 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1708 @} else @{
1709 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1710 @}
1711 @end example
1712 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1713
1714 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1715 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1716 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1717
1718 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1719 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1720 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1721
1722 @example
1723 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1724 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1725 @end example
1726
1727 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1728 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1729 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1730 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1731 for taps.
1732
1733 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1734 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1735 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1736 looks (in part) like this:
1737
1738 @example
1739 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1740 @end example
1741
1742 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1743 to source such a config file twice, with different
1744 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1745 it adds a different TAP each time.
1746
1747 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1748 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1749 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1750 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1751
1752 @example
1753 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1754 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1755 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1756 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1757 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1758 @end example
1759
1760 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1761 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1762
1763 @itemize
1764 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1765 plus a JRC to enable them
1766 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1767 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1768 is not currently used)
1769 @end itemize
1770
1771 @subsection Add CPU targets
1772
1773 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1774 GDB and other commands can use it.
1775 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1776 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1777 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1778 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1779
1780 @example
1781 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1782 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1783 @end example
1784
1785 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1786 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1787 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1788 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1789 a work area if you can.
1790 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1791
1792 @example
1793 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1794 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1795 @end example
1796
1797 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1798 @cindex SMP
1799 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1800
1801 @example
1802 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1803 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1804 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1805 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1806 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1807 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1808 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1809 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1810 @end example
1811 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1812 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1813 @itemize @bullet
1814 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1815 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1816 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1817 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1818 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1819 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1820 @end itemize
1821
1822 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1823 command have been implemented.
1824 @itemize @bullet
1825 @item cortex_a smp on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1826 @item cortex_a smp off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1827 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1828 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1829 @item cortex_a smp : display current SMP mode.
1830 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1831 following example.
1832 @end itemize
1833
1834 @example
1835 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1836 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1837 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1838 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1839 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1840 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1841 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1842 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1843 > resume
1844 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1845 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1846 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1847 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1848 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1849 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1850 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1851 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1852 @end example
1853
1854
1855 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1856
1857 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1858 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1859 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1860
1861 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1862 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1863 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1864 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1865 both signals.
1866
1867 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1868 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1869 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1870 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1871 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1872 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1873 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1874 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1875 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1876 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1877 not available.)
1878
1879 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1880 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1881 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1882 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1883 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1884 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1885 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1886 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1887
1888 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1889 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1890 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1891 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1892 slower clock than they will use later.
1893 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1894 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1895 than they will use later.
1896 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1897
1898 @quotation Important
1899 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1900 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1901 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1902 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1903 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1904 @end quotation
1905
1906 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1907 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1908 @cindex init_targets procedure
1909
1910 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1911 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1912 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1913 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1914 Such procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1915 This concept facilitates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1916 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enhanced or changed in
1917 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1918 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1919
1920 @example
1921 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1922
1923 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1924 # basic initialization procedure ...
1925 @}
1926
1927 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1928 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1929 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1930 @}
1931
1932 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1933
1934 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1935
1936 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1937 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1938 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1939 @}
1940 @end example
1941
1942 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1943 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1944
1945 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1946
1947 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1948 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1949
1950 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1951 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1952
1953 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1954 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1955 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1956 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1957 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1958 events already assigned.
1959
1960 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1961
1962 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1963 special high speed download features - enable it.
1964
1965 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1966
1967 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1968 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1969 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1970 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1971 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1972 If you are using an external trace port,
1973 configure it in your board config file.
1974 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1975 configure it in your target config file.
1976
1977 @example
1978 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1979 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1980 @end example
1981
1982 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1983
1984 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1985
1986 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1987 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1988 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1989 the TARGET (chip) file.
1990
1991 Examples:
1992 @itemize @bullet
1993 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1994 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1995 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1996 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1997 @end itemize
1998
1999 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
2000 @section Translating Configuration Files
2001 @cindex translation
2002 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
2003 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
2004 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
2005 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
2006 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
2007 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
2008
2009 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
2010 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
2011 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
2012 convert other scripts later on.
2013
2014 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
2015 replace job:
2016
2017 @example
2018 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
2019 #
2020 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
2021 #
2022 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
2023 #
2024 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
2025
2026 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
2027 global TARGETNAME
2028
2029 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
2030
2031 arm mcr 15 [expr @{($regs >> 12) & 0x7@}] \
2032 [expr @{($regs >> 0) & 0xf@}] [expr @{($regs >> 4) & 0xf@}] \
2033 [expr @{($regs >> 8) & 0x7@}] $value
2034 @}
2035 @end example
2036
2037
2038
2039 @node Server Configuration
2040 @chapter Server Configuration
2041 @cindex initialization
2042 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2043 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2044 supported.
2045
2046 @anchor{configurationstage}
2047 @section Configuration Stage
2048 @cindex configuration stage
2049 @cindex config command
2050
2051 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2052 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2053 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2054 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2055 inside startup scripts.
2056
2057 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2058 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2059 which may be issued interactively.
2060 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2061 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2062
2063 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2064 flash banks,
2065 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2066 and other basic setup.
2067 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2068 may access or activate TAPs.
2069 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2070 longer be issued.
2071
2072 @deffn {Command} {command mode} [command_name]
2073 Returns the command modes allowed by a command: 'any', 'config', or
2074 'exec'. If no command is specified, returns the current command
2075 mode. Returns 'unknown' if an unknown command is given. Command can be
2076 multiple tokens. (command valid any time)
2077
2078 In this document, the modes are described as stages, 'config' and
2079 'exec' mode correspond configuration stage and run stage. 'any' means
2080 the command can be executed in either
2081 stages. @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}, and
2082 @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.
2083 @end deffn
2084
2085 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2086 @section Entering the Run Stage
2087
2088 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2089 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2090 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2091 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2092 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2093 You should see no errors at this point.
2094 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2095 commands you used to configure the server.
2096 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2097 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2098 on the scan chain.
2099
2100 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2101 become available.
2102 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2103 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2104 a target has been successfully instantiated.
2105 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2106 entry to the run stage.
2107
2108 @deffn {Config Command} {init}
2109 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2110 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2111 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2112 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2113 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2114 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2115
2116 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2117 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2118 configuration files and/or command line options.
2119
2120 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs near the end of your
2121 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2122 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2123 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2124 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2125
2126 @command{init} calls the following internal OpenOCD commands to initialize
2127 corresponding subsystems:
2128 @deffn {Config Command} {target init}
2129 @deffnx {Command} {transport init}
2130 @deffnx {Command} {dap init}
2131 @deffnx {Config Command} {flash init}
2132 @deffnx {Config Command} {nand init}
2133 @deffnx {Config Command} {pld init}
2134 @deffnx {Command} {tpiu init}
2135 @end deffn
2136
2137 At last, @command{init} executes all the commands that are specified in
2138 the TCL list @var{post_init_commands}. The commands are executed in the
2139 same order they occupy in the list. If one of the commands fails, then
2140 the error is propagated and OpenOCD fails too.
2141 @example
2142 lappend post_init_commands @{echo "OpenOCD successfully initialized."@}
2143 lappend post_init_commands @{echo "Have fun with OpenOCD !"@}
2144 @end example
2145 @end deffn
2146
2147 @deffn {Config Command} {noinit}
2148 Prevent OpenOCD from implicit @command{init} call at the end of startup.
2149 Allows issuing configuration commands over telnet or Tcl connection.
2150 When you are done with configuration use @command{init} to enter
2151 the run stage.
2152 @end deffn
2153
2154 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} {jtag_init}
2155 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2156 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2157
2158 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2159 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2160 scan chain.
2161 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2162 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2163
2164 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2165 they return.
2166 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2167 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2168 @end deffn
2169
2170 @anchor{tcpipports}
2171 @section TCP/IP Ports
2172 @cindex TCP port
2173 @cindex server
2174 @cindex port
2175 @cindex security
2176 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2177 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2178 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2179
2180 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2181 access using one or more of these ports.
2182 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
2183 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2184 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2185
2186 You can request the operating system to select one of the available
2187 ports for the server by specifying the relevant port number as "0".
2188
2189 @anchor{gdb_port}
2190 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_port} [number]
2191 @cindex GDB server
2192 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2193 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2194 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2195 the normal use cases.
2196
2197 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2198 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
2199 disables the gdb server.
2200
2201 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2202 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2203
2204 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2205 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2206 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2207
2208 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2209 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2210 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2211 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2212 When @var{number} is not a numeric value, incrementing it to compute
2213 the next port number does not work. In this case, specify the proper
2214 @var{number} for each target by using the option @code{-gdb-port} of the
2215 commands @command{target create} or @command{$target_name configure}.
2216 @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.
2217
2218 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2219 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2220 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2221 @end deffn
2222
2223 @deffn {Config Command} {tcl_port} [number]
2224 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2225 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2226 output from the Tcl engine.
2227 Intended as a machine interface.
2228 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2229 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2230 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2231 @end deffn
2232
2233 @deffn {Config Command} {telnet_port} [number]
2234 Specify or query the
2235 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2236 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2237 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2238 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2239 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2240 @end deffn
2241
2242 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2243 @section GDB Configuration
2244 @cindex GDB
2245 @cindex GDB configuration
2246 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2247 The ones listed here are static and global.
2248 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2249 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2250
2251 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2252 @deffn {Command} {gdb_breakpoint_override} [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2253 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2254 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2255 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2256 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2257 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2258 @end deffn
2259
2260 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2261 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_flash_program} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2262 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2263 vFlash packet is received.
2264 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2265 @end deffn
2266
2267 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_memory_map} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2268 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2269 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2270 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2271 for flash programming to work.
2272 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2273 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2274 @end deffn
2275
2276 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_report_data_abort} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2277 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2278 by GDB memory read packets.
2279 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2280 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2281 @end deffn
2282
2283 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_report_register_access_error} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2284 Specifies whether register accesses requested by GDB register read/write
2285 packets report errors or not.
2286 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2287 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2288 @end deffn
2289
2290 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_target_description} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2291 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2292 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2293 @end deffn
2294
2295 @deffn {Command} {gdb_save_tdesc}
2296 Saves the target description file to the local file system.
2297
2298 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2299 @end deffn
2300
2301 @anchor{eventpolling}
2302 @section Event Polling
2303
2304 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2305 where significant events can happen at any time.
2306 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2307 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2308 or to GDB.
2309
2310 Examples of such events include:
2311
2312 @itemize
2313 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2314 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2315 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2316 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2317 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2318 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2319 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2320 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2321 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2322 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2323 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2324 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2325 @end itemize
2326
2327 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2328 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2329 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2330 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2331 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2332
2333 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2334 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2335 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2336 to the various active targets.
2337 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2338 which is normally done in the background.
2339
2340 @deffn {Command} {poll} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2341 Poll the current target for its current state.
2342 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2343 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2344 specific information about the current state is printed.
2345 An optional parameter
2346 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2347
2348 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2349 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2350 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2351 @example
2352 > poll
2353 background polling: on
2354 target state: halted
2355 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2356 current mode: Supervisor
2357 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2358 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2359 >
2360 @end example
2361 @end deffn
2362
2363 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2364 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2365 @cindex config file, interface
2366 @cindex interface config file
2367
2368 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2369 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2370 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2371
2372 @quotation Note
2373 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2374 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2375 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2376 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2377 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2378 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2379 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2380 @end quotation
2381
2382 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2383 through commands in an interface configuration
2384 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2385 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2386
2387 @example
2388 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2389 @end example
2390
2391 These commands tell
2392 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2393 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2394
2395 @example
2396 # jlink interface
2397 adapter driver jlink
2398 @end example
2399
2400 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2401
2402
2403 @section Adapter Configuration
2404
2405 The @command{adapter driver} command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2406 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2407 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2408
2409 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter driver} name
2410 Use the adapter driver @var{name} to connect to the
2411 target.
2412 @end deffn
2413
2414 @deffn {Command} {adapter list}
2415 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2416 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2417 @end deffn
2418 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter transports} transport_name+
2419 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2420 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2421 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2422 the hardware can support.
2423 @end deffn
2424
2425 @anchor{adapter gpio}
2426 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter gpio [ @
2427 @option{tdo} | @option{tdi} | @option{tms} | @option{tck} | @option{trst} | @
2428 @option{swdio} | @option{swdio_dir} | @option{swclk} | @option{srst} | @
2429 @option{led} @
2430 [ @
2431 gpio_number | @option{-chip} chip_number | @
2432 @option{-active-high} | @option{-active-low} | @
2433 @option{-push-pull} | @option{-open-drain} | @option{-open-source} | @
2434 @option{-pull-none} | @option{-pull-up} | @option{-pull-down} | @
2435 @option{-init-inactive} | @option{-init-active} | @option{-init-input} @
2436 ] ]}
2437
2438 Define the GPIO mapping that the adapter will use. The following signals can be
2439 defined:
2440
2441 @itemize @minus
2442 @item @option{tdo}, @option{tdi}, @option{tms}, @option{tck}, @option{trst}:
2443 JTAG transport signals
2444 @item @option{swdio}, @option{swclk}: SWD transport signals
2445 @item @option{swdio_dir}: optional swdio buffer control signal
2446 @item @option{srst}: system reset signal
2447 @item @option{led}: optional activity led
2448
2449 @end itemize
2450
2451 Some adapters require that the GPIO chip number is set in addition to the GPIO
2452 number. The configuration options enable signals to be defined as active-high or
2453 active-low. The output drive mode can be set to push-pull, open-drain or
2454 open-source. Most adapters will have to emulate open-drain or open-source drive
2455 modes by switching between an input and output. Input and output signals can be
2456 instructed to use a pull-up or pull-down resistor, assuming it is supported by
2457 the adaptor driver and hardware. The initial state of outputs may also be set,
2458 "active" state means 1 for active-high outputs and 0 for active-low outputs.
2459 Bidirectional signals may also be initialized as an input. If the swdio signal
2460 is buffered the buffer direction can be controlled with the swdio_dir signal;
2461 the active state means that the buffer should be set as an output with respect
2462 to the adapter. The command options are cumulative with later commands able to
2463 override settings defined by earlier ones. The two commands @command{gpio led 7
2464 -active-high} and @command{gpio led -chip 1 -active-low} sent sequentially are
2465 equivalent to issuing the single command @command{gpio led 7 -chip 1
2466 -active-low}. It is not permissible to set the drive mode or initial state for
2467 signals which are inputs. The drive mode for the srst and trst signals must be
2468 set with the @command{adapter reset_config} command. It is not permissible to
2469 set the initial state of swdio_dir as it is derived from the initial state of
2470 swdio. The command @command{adapter gpio} prints the current configuration for
2471 all GPIOs while the command @command{adapter gpio gpio_name} prints the current
2472 configuration for gpio_name. Not all adapters support this generic GPIO mapping,
2473 some require their own commands to define the GPIOs used. Adapters that support
2474 the generic mapping may not support all of the listed options.
2475 @end deffn
2476
2477 @deffn {Command} {adapter name}
2478 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2479 @end deffn
2480
2481 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter usb location} [<bus>-<port>[.<port>]...]
2482 Displays or specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2483 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2484 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2485 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2486 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t} or @emph{dmesg}.
2487
2488 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2489 @end deffn
2490
2491 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter serial} serial_string
2492 Specifies the @var{serial_string} of the adapter to use.
2493 If this command is not specified, serial strings are not checked.
2494 Only the following adapter drivers use the serial string from this command:
2495 arm-jtag-ew, cmsis_dap, esp_usb_jtag, ft232r, ftdi, hla (stlink, ti-icdi), jlink, kitprog, opendus,
2496 openjtag, osbdm, presto, rlink, st-link, usb_blaster (ublast2), usbprog, vsllink, xds110.
2497 @end deffn
2498
2499 @section Interface Drivers
2500
2501 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2502 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2503 available at run time.
2504
2505 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2506 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2507 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2508 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2509
2510 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} number
2511 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2512 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2513 @end deffn
2514
2515 @deffn {Config Command} {rtck} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2516 Displays status of RTCK option.
2517 Optionally sets that option first.
2518 @end deffn
2519 @end deffn
2520
2521 @deffn {Interface Driver} {angie}
2522 This is the NanoXplore's ANGIE USB-JTAG Adapter.
2523 @end deffn
2524
2525 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2526 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2527 This has one driver-specific command:
2528
2529 @deffn {Command} {armjtagew_info}
2530 Logs some status
2531 @end deffn
2532 @end deffn
2533
2534 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2535 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2536 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2537 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2538 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2539 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2540 @end deffn
2541
2542 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2543 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter v1 (USB HID based)
2544 or v2 (USB bulk).
2545
2546 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis-dap vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2547 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2548 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2549 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2550 @example
2551 cmsis-dap vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2552 @end example
2553 @end deffn
2554
2555 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis-dap backend} [@option{auto}|@option{usb_bulk}|@option{hid}]
2556 Specifies how to communicate with the adapter:
2557
2558 @itemize @minus
2559 @item @option{hid} Use HID generic reports - CMSIS-DAP v1
2560 @item @option{usb_bulk} Use USB bulk - CMSIS-DAP v2
2561 @item @option{auto} First try USB bulk CMSIS-DAP v2, if not found try HID CMSIS-DAP v1.
2562 This is the default if @command{cmsis-dap backend} is not specified.
2563 @end itemize
2564 @end deffn
2565
2566 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis-dap usb interface} [number]
2567 Specifies the @var{number} of the USB interface to use in v2 mode (USB bulk).
2568 In most cases need not to be specified and interfaces are searched by
2569 interface string or for user class interface.
2570 @end deffn
2571
2572 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap quirk} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2573 Enables or disables the following workarounds of known CMSIS-DAP adapter
2574 quirks:
2575 @itemize @minus
2576 @item disconnect and re-connect before sending a switch sequence
2577 @item packets pipelining is suppressed, only one packet at a time is
2578 submitted to the adapter
2579 @end itemize
2580 The quirk workarounds are disabled by default.
2581 The command without a parameter displays current setting.
2582 @end deffn
2583
2584 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2585 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2586 @end deffn
2587
2588 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap cmd} number number ...
2589 Execute an arbitrary CMSIS-DAP command. Use for adapter testing or for handling
2590 of an adapter vendor specific command from a Tcl script.
2591
2592 Take given numbers as bytes, assemble a CMSIS-DAP protocol command packet
2593 from them and send it to the adapter. The first 4 bytes of the adapter response
2594 are logged.
2595 See @url{https://arm-software.github.io/CMSIS_5/DAP/html/group__DAP__Commands__gr.html}
2596 @end deffn
2597 @end deffn
2598
2599 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2600 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2601 @end deffn
2602
2603 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2604 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2605 @end deffn
2606
2607 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2608 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2609 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2610
2611 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2612 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi.
2613
2614 Support for new FTDI based adapters can be added completely through
2615 configuration files, without the need to patch and rebuild OpenOCD.
2616
2617 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2618 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2619 controlled using the @command{ftdi set_signal} command. Special signal names
2620 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2621 will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
2622 @command{ftdi get_signal} command.
2623
2624 To support SWD, a signal named SWD_EN must be defined. It is set to 1 when the
2625 SWD protocol is selected. When set, the adapter should route the SWDIO pin to
2626 the data input. An SWDIO_OE signal, if defined, will be set to 1 or 0 as
2627 required by the protocol, to tell the adapter to drive the data output onto
2628 the SWDIO pin or keep the SWDIO pin Hi-Z, respectively.
2629
2630 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2631 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2632 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2633 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2634
2635 @itemize @minus
2636 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2637 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2638 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2639 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2640 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2641 switching data and direction as necessary
2642 @end itemize
2643
2644 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2645 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2646
2647 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2648 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. Up to eight
2649 [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2650 @example
2651 ftdi vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2652 @end example
2653 @end deffn
2654
2655 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi device_desc} description
2656 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2657 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2658 during device selection.
2659 @end deffn
2660
2661 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi channel} channel
2662 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2663 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2664 @end deffn
2665
2666 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi layout_init} data direction
2667 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2668 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2669 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2670 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2671 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2672 and initially asserted reset signals.
2673 @end deffn
2674
2675 @deffn {Command} {ftdi layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2676 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2677 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2678 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2679 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2680 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2681 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2682 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2683 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
2684 @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
2685 with the method @command{ftdi get_signal}.
2686
2687 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2688 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2689 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2690 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2691 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2692 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2693
2694 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2695 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2696 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2697 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2698 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2699 are always driven by the FTDI.
2700
2701 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2702 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2703 @var{name}.
2704 @end deffn
2705
2706 @deffn {Command} {ftdi set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2707 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2708 @itemize @minus
2709 @item @option{0}, drive low
2710 @item @option{1}, drive high
2711 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2712 @end itemize
2713 @end deffn
2714
2715 @deffn {Command} {ftdi get_signal} name
2716 Get the value of a previously defined signal.
2717 @end deffn
2718
2719 @deffn {Command} {ftdi tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2720 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2721
2722 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2723 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possibility to sample
2724 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2725 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2726 @itemize @minus
2727 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2728 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2729 @end itemize
2730 @end deffn
2731
2732 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2733 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2734
2735 @end deffn
2736
2737 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft232r}
2738 This driver is implementing synchronous bitbang mode of an FTDI FT232R,
2739 FT230X, FT231X and similar USB UART bridge ICs by reusing RS232 signals as GPIO.
2740 It currently doesn't support using CBUS pins as GPIO.
2741
2742 List of connections (default physical pin numbers for FT232R in 28-pin SSOP package):
2743 @itemize @minus
2744 @item RXD(5) - TDI
2745 @item TXD(1) - TCK
2746 @item RTS(3) - TDO
2747 @item CTS(11) - TMS
2748 @item DTR(2) - TRST
2749 @item DCD(10) - SRST
2750 @end itemize
2751
2752 User can change default pinout by supplying configuration
2753 commands with GPIO numbers or RS232 signal names.
2754 GPIO numbers correspond to bit numbers in FTDI GPIO register.
2755 They differ from physical pin numbers.
2756 For details see actual FTDI chip datasheets.
2757 Every JTAG line must be configured to unique GPIO number
2758 different than any other JTAG line, even those lines
2759 that are sometimes not used like TRST or SRST.
2760
2761 FT232R
2762 @itemize @minus
2763 @item bit 7 - RI
2764 @item bit 6 - DCD
2765 @item bit 5 - DSR
2766 @item bit 4 - DTR
2767 @item bit 3 - CTS
2768 @item bit 2 - RTS
2769 @item bit 1 - RXD
2770 @item bit 0 - TXD
2771 @end itemize
2772
2773 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2774 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2775
2776 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r vid_pid} @var{vid} @var{pid}
2777 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, default
2778 0x0403:0x6001 is used.
2779 @end deffn
2780
2781 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
2782 Set four JTAG GPIO numbers at once.
2783 If not specified, default 0 3 1 2 or TXD CTS RXD RTS is used.
2784 @end deffn
2785
2786 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tck_num} @var{tck}
2787 Set TCK GPIO number. If not specified, default 0 or TXD is used.
2788 @end deffn
2789
2790 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tms_num} @var{tms}
2791 Set TMS GPIO number. If not specified, default 3 or CTS is used.
2792 @end deffn
2793
2794 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tdi_num} @var{tdi}
2795 Set TDI GPIO number. If not specified, default 1 or RXD is used.
2796 @end deffn
2797
2798 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tdo_num} @var{tdo}
2799 Set TDO GPIO number. If not specified, default 2 or RTS is used.
2800 @end deffn
2801
2802 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r trst_num} @var{trst}
2803 Set TRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 4 or DTR is used.
2804 @end deffn
2805
2806 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r srst_num} @var{srst}
2807 Set SRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 6 or DCD is used.
2808 @end deffn
2809
2810 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r restore_serial} @var{word}
2811 Restore serial port after JTAG. This USB bitmode control word
2812 (16-bit) will be sent before quit. Lower byte should
2813 set GPIO direction register to a "sane" state:
2814 0x15 for TXD RTS DTR as outputs (1), others as inputs (0). Higher
2815 byte is usually 0 to disable bitbang mode.
2816 When kernel driver reattaches, serial port should continue to work.
2817 Value 0xFFFF disables sending control word and serial port,
2818 then kernel driver will not reattach.
2819 If not specified, default 0xFFFF is used.
2820 @end deffn
2821
2822 @end deffn
2823
2824 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2825 Drive JTAG and SWD from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket
2826 connection with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to
2827 that process instead of directly driving JTAG and SWD.
2828
2829 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2830 processors which are being simulated.
2831
2832 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang port} number
2833 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2834 sockets instead of TCP.
2835 @end deffn
2836
2837 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang host} hostname
2838 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2839 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang port is 0.
2840 @end deffn
2841
2842 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang use_remote_sleep} (on|off)
2843 If this option is enabled, delays will not be executed locally but instead
2844 forwarded to the remote host. This is useful if the remote host performs its
2845 own request queuing rather than executing requests immediately.
2846
2847 This is disabled by default. This option must only be enabled if the given
2848 remote_bitbang host supports receiving the delay information.
2849 @end deffn
2850
2851 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2852 something like:
2853
2854 @example
2855 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2856 remote_bitbang port 3335
2857 remote_bitbang host foobar
2858 @end example
2859
2860 And if you also wished to enable remote sleeping:
2861
2862 @example
2863 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2864 remote_bitbang port 3335
2865 remote_bitbang host foobar
2866 remote_bitbang use_remote_sleep on
2867 @end example
2868
2869 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2870 named mysocket:
2871
2872 @example
2873 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2874 remote_bitbang port 0
2875 remote_bitbang host mysocket
2876 @end example
2877 @end deffn
2878
2879 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2880 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2881 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2882 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2883
2884 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster vid_pid} vid pid
2885 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2886 default values are used.
2887 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2888 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2889 @example
2890 usb_blaster vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2891 @end example
2892 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2893 @example
2894 usb_blaster vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2895 @end example
2896 @end deffn
2897
2898 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2899 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2900 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2901 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2902 target board.
2903
2904 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2905 @example
2906 usb_blaster pin pin6 s
2907 reset_config srst_only
2908 @end example
2909 @end deffn
2910
2911 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
2912 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2913 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2914 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2915 @end deffn
2916
2917 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster firmware} @var{path}
2918 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2919 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2920 @end deffn
2921
2922 @end deffn
2923
2924 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2925 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2926 This has one driver-specific command:
2927
2928 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} [port_number]
2929 Display either the address of the I/O port
2930 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2931 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2932 This is a write-once setting.
2933 @end deffn
2934 @end deffn
2935
2936 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2937 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2938 transports.
2939
2940 @quotation Compatibility Note
2941 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many hardware versions they
2942 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2943 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2944 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2945 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2946 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2947 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2948 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2949 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2950 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2951 @end quotation
2952
2953 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2954 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2955 states.
2956 @end deffn
2957 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2958 Display free device internal memory.
2959 @end deffn
2960 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2961 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2962 command version.
2963 @end deffn
2964 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2965 Display the device configuration.
2966 @end deffn
2967 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2968 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2969 power state.
2970 @end deffn
2971 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2972 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2973 @end deffn
2974 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2975 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2976 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2977 IP configuration.
2978 @end deffn
2979 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2980 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2981 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2982 @end deffn
2983 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2984 Reset the current configuration.
2985 @end deffn
2986 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2987 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2988 @end deffn
2989 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom write} <channel> <data>
2990 Write data to an EMUCOM channel. The data needs to be encoded as hexadecimal
2991 pairs.
2992
2993 The following example shows how to write the three bytes 0xaa, 0x0b and 0x23 to
2994 the EMUCOM channel 0x10:
2995 @example
2996 > jlink emucom write 0x10 aa0b23
2997 @end example
2998 @end deffn
2999 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom read} <channel> <length>
3000 Read data from an EMUCOM channel. The read data is encoded as hexadecimal
3001 pairs.
3002
3003 The following example shows how to read 4 bytes from the EMUCOM channel 0x0:
3004 @example
3005 > jlink emucom read 0x0 4
3006 77a90000
3007 @end example
3008 @end deffn
3009 @deffn {Config Command} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
3010 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
3011 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
3012 selection via USB address is not always unambiguous. It is recommended to use
3013 the serial number instead, if possible.
3014
3015 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
3016 @end deffn
3017 @end deffn
3018
3019 @deffn {Interface Driver} {kitprog}
3020 This driver is for Cypress Semiconductor's KitProg adapters. The KitProg is an
3021 SWD-only adapter that is designed to be used with Cypress's PSoC and PRoC device
3022 families, but it is possible to use it with some other devices. If you are using
3023 this adapter with a PSoC or a PRoC, you may need to add
3024 @command{kitprog init_acquire_psoc} or @command{kitprog acquire_psoc} to your
3025 configuration script.
3026
3027 Note that this driver is for the proprietary KitProg protocol, not the CMSIS-DAP
3028 mode introduced in firmware 2.14. If the KitProg is in CMSIS-DAP mode, it cannot
3029 be used with this driver, and must either be used with the cmsis-dap driver or
3030 switched back to KitProg mode. See the Cypress KitProg User Guide for
3031 instructions on how to switch KitProg modes.
3032
3033 Known limitations:
3034 @itemize @bullet
3035 @item The frequency of SWCLK cannot be configured, and varies between 1.6 MHz
3036 and 2.7 MHz.
3037 @item For firmware versions below 2.14, "JTAG to SWD" sequences are replaced by
3038 "SWD line reset" in the driver. This is for two reasons. First, the KitProg does
3039 not support sending arbitrary SWD sequences, and only firmware 2.14 and later
3040 implement both "JTAG to SWD" and "SWD line reset" in firmware. Earlier firmware
3041 versions only implement "SWD line reset". Second, due to a firmware quirk, an
3042 SWD sequence must be sent after every target reset in order to re-establish
3043 communications with the target.
3044 @item Due in part to the limitation above, KitProg devices with firmware below
3045 version 2.14 will need to use @command{kitprog init_acquire_psoc} in order to
3046 communicate with PSoC 5LP devices. This is because, assuming debug is not
3047 disabled on the PSoC, the PSoC 5LP needs its JTAG interface switched to SWD
3048 mode before communication can begin, but prior to firmware 2.14, "JTAG to SWD"
3049 could only be sent with an acquisition sequence.
3050 @end itemize
3051
3052 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog init_acquire_psoc}
3053 Indicate that a PSoC acquisition sequence needs to be run during adapter init.
3054 Please be aware that the acquisition sequence hard-resets the target.
3055 @end deffn
3056
3057 @deffn {Command} {kitprog acquire_psoc}
3058 Run a PSoC acquisition sequence immediately. Typically, this should not be used
3059 outside of the target-specific configuration scripts since it hard-resets the
3060 target as a side-effect.
3061 This is necessary for "reset halt" on some PSoC 4 series devices.
3062 @end deffn
3063
3064 @deffn {Command} {kitprog info}
3065 Display various adapter information, such as the hardware version, firmware
3066 version, and target voltage.
3067 @end deffn
3068 @end deffn
3069
3070 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
3071 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
3072 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
3073 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
3074 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
3075
3076 @deffn {Config Command} {parport cable} name
3077 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
3078 This is a write-once setting.
3079 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
3080
3081 @itemize @minus
3082 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
3083 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
3084 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
3085 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
3086 in configuration mode. This is only used to
3087 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
3088 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
3089 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
3090 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
3091 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
3092 some versions of
3093 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
3094 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
3095 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
3096 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
3097 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
3098 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
3099 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
3100 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
3101 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
3102 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
3103 @end itemize
3104 @end deffn
3105
3106 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} [port_number]
3107 Display either the address of the I/O port
3108 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
3109 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
3110 This is a write-once setting.
3111
3112 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
3113 @option{parport port 0} (the default). If @option{parport port 0x378} is specified
3114 you may encounter a problem.
3115 @end deffn
3116
3117 @deffn {Config Command} {parport toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
3118 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
3119 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
3120 @command{adapter speed} configuration.
3121 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
3122 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
3123
3124 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
3125 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
3126 @quotation Tip
3127 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
3128 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
3129 @example
3130 > parport toggling_time 1000
3131 > adapter speed 500
3132 @end example
3133 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
3134 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
3135 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
3136 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
3137 large set of samples.
3138 Update the setting to match your measurement:
3139 @example
3140 > parport toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
3141 @end example
3142 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter speed}
3143 command given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
3144
3145 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
3146 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
3147 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
3148 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
3149 match with the rate you specified in the @command{adapter speed} command;
3150 be conservative.
3151 @end quotation
3152 @end deffn
3153
3154 @deffn {Config Command} {parport write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
3155 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
3156 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
3157 @end deffn
3158
3159 For example, the interface configuration file for a
3160 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
3161
3162 @example
3163 adapter driver parport
3164 parport port 0x278
3165 parport cable wiggler
3166 @end example
3167 @end deffn
3168
3169 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
3170 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
3171 @end deffn
3172
3173 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
3174 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
3175 @end deffn
3176
3177 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
3178 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3179 @end deffn
3180
3181 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
3182 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
3183
3184 @quotation Note
3185 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
3186 which are not currently documented here.
3187 @end quotation
3188 @end deffn
3189
3190 @anchor{hla_interface}
3191 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
3192 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
3193 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
3194 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
3195
3196 Currently supported adapters include the STMicroelectronics ST-LINK, TI ICDI
3197 and Nuvoton Nu-Link.
3198 ST-LINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
3199 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
3200 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade ST-LINK firmware even if current
3201 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
3202
3203 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
3204 Currently Not Supported.
3205 @end deffn
3206
3207 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi}|@option{nulink})
3208 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
3209 @end deffn
3210
3211 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3212 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3213 @end deffn
3214
3215 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_stlink_backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3216 @emph{ST-Link only:} Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3217 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3218
3219 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3220 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3221 ST-LINK server software module}.
3222 @end deffn
3223
3224 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
3225 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
3226 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
3227 @end deffn
3228 @end deffn
3229
3230 @anchor{st_link_dap_interface}
3231 @deffn {Interface Driver} {st-link}
3232 This is a driver that supports STMicroelectronics adapters ST-LINK/V2
3233 (from firmware V2J24), STLINK-V3 and STLINK-V3PWR, thanks to a new API that provides
3234 directly access the arm ADIv5 DAP.
3235
3236 The new API provide access to multiple AP on the same DAP, but the
3237 maximum number of the AP port is limited by the specific firmware version
3238 (e.g. firmware V2J29 has 3 as maximum AP number, while V2J32 has 8).
3239 An error is returned for any AP number above the maximum allowed value.
3240
3241 @emph{Note:} Either these same adapters and their older versions are
3242 also supported by @ref{hla_interface, the hla interface driver}.
3243
3244 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3245 Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3246 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3247
3248 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3249 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3250 ST-LINK server software module}.
3251
3252 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server does not support the SWIM transport.
3253 @end deffn
3254
3255 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3256 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3257 @end deffn
3258
3259 @deffn {Command} {st-link cmd} rx_n (tx_byte)+
3260 Sends an arbitrary command composed by the sequence of bytes @var{tx_byte}
3261 and receives @var{rx_n} bytes.
3262
3263 For example, the command to read the target's supply voltage is one byte 0xf7 followed
3264 by 15 bytes zero. It returns 8 bytes, where the first 4 bytes represent the ADC sampling
3265 of the reference voltage 1.2V and the last 4 bytes represent the ADC sampling of half
3266 the target's supply voltage.
3267 @example
3268 > st-link cmd 8 0xf7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
3269 0xf1 0x05 0x00 0x00 0x0b 0x08 0x00 0x00
3270 @end example
3271 The result can be converted to Volts (ignoring the most significant bytes, always zero)
3272 @example
3273 > set a [st-link cmd 8 0xf7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0]
3274 > set n [expr @{[lindex $a 4] + 256 * [lindex $a 5]@}]
3275 > set d [expr @{[lindex $a 0] + 256 * [lindex $a 1]@}]
3276 > echo [expr @{2 * 1.2 * $n / $d@}]
3277 3.24891518738
3278 @end example
3279 @end deffn
3280 @end deffn
3281
3282 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
3283 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3284 @end deffn
3285
3286 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
3287 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
3288 @end deffn
3289
3290 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xds110}
3291 The XDS110 is included as the embedded debug probe on many Texas Instruments
3292 LaunchPad evaluation boards. The XDS110 is also available as a stand-alone USB
3293 debug probe with the added capability to supply power to the target board. The
3294 following commands are supported by the XDS110 driver:
3295
3296 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 supply} voltage_in_millivolts
3297 Available only on the XDS110 stand-alone probe. Sets the voltage level of the
3298 XDS110 power supply. A value of 0 leaves the supply off. Otherwise, the supply
3299 can be set to any value in the range 1800 to 3600 millivolts.
3300 @end deffn
3301
3302 @deffn {Command} {xds110 info}
3303 Displays information about the connected XDS110 debug probe (e.g. firmware
3304 version).
3305 @end deffn
3306 @end deffn
3307
3308 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xlnx_pcie_xvc}
3309 This driver supports the Xilinx Virtual Cable (XVC) over PCI Express.
3310 It is commonly found in Xilinx based PCI Express designs. It allows debugging
3311 fabric based JTAG/SWD devices such as Cortex-M1/M3 microcontrollers. Access to this is
3312 exposed via extended capability registers in the PCI Express configuration space.
3313
3314 For more information see Xilinx PG245 (Section on From_PCIE_to_JTAG mode).
3315
3316 @deffn {Config Command} {xlnx_pcie_xvc config} device
3317 Specifies the PCI Express device via parameter @var{device} to use.
3318
3319 The correct value for @var{device} can be obtained by looking at the output
3320 of lscpi -D (first column) for the corresponding device.
3321
3322 The string will be of the format "DDDD:BB:SS.F" such as "0000:65:00.1".
3323
3324 @end deffn
3325 @end deffn
3326
3327 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
3328 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
3329 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
3330
3331 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
3332 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
3333 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
3334 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
3335 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
3336 configuration on exit.
3337
3338 GPIO numbers >= 32 can't be used for performance reasons. GPIO configuration is
3339 handled by the generic command @ref{adapter gpio, @command{adapter gpio}}.
3340
3341 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3342 @file{interface/raspberrypi-gpio-connector.cfg} for pinout.
3343
3344 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio speed_coeffs} @var{speed_coeff} @var{speed_offset}
3345 Set SPEED_COEFF and SPEED_OFFSET for delay calculations. If unspecified,
3346 speed_coeff defaults to 113714, and speed_offset defaults to 28.
3347 @end deffn
3348
3349 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio peripheral_mem_dev} @var{device}
3350 Set the device path for access to the memory mapped GPIO control registers.
3351 Uses @file{/dev/gpiomem} by default, this is also the preferred option with
3352 respect to system security.
3353 If overridden to @file{/dev/mem}:
3354 @itemize @minus
3355 @item OpenOCD needs @code{cap_sys_rawio} or run as root to open @file{/dev/mem}.
3356 Please be aware of security issues imposed by running OpenOCD with
3357 elevated user rights and by @file{/dev/mem} itself.
3358 @item correct @command{peripheral_base} must be configured.
3359 @item GPIO 0-27 pads are set to the limited slew rate
3360 and drive strength is reduced to 4 mA (2 mA on RPi 4).
3361 @end itemize
3362
3363 @end deffn
3364
3365 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio peripheral_base} @var{base}
3366 Set the peripheral base register address to access GPIOs.
3367 Ignored if @file{/dev/gpiomem} is used. For the RPi1, use
3368 0x20000000. For RPi2 and RPi3, use 0x3F000000. For RPi4, use 0xFE000000. A full
3369 list can be found in the
3370 @uref{https://www.raspberrypi.org/documentation/hardware/raspberrypi/peripheral_addresses.md, official guide}.
3371 @end deffn
3372
3373 @end deffn
3374
3375 @deffn {Interface Driver} {imx_gpio}
3376 i.MX SoC is present in many community boards. Wandboard is an example
3377 of the one which is most popular.
3378
3379 This driver is mostly the same as bcm2835gpio.
3380
3381 See @file{interface/imx-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3382 pinout.
3383
3384 @end deffn
3385
3386
3387 @deffn {Interface Driver} {am335xgpio} The AM335x SoC is present in BeagleBone
3388 Black and BeagleBone Green single-board computers which expose some of the GPIOs
3389 on the two expansion headers.
3390
3391 For maximum performance the driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral
3392 registers directly. The memory mapping requires read and write permission to
3393 kernel memory; if /dev/gpiomem exists it will be used, otherwise /dev/mem will
3394 be used. The driver restores the GPIO state on exit.
3395
3396 All four GPIO ports are available. GPIO configuration is handled by the generic
3397 command @ref{adapter gpio, @command{adapter gpio}}.
3398
3399 @deffn {Config Command} {am335xgpio speed_coeffs} @var{speed_coeff} @var{speed_offset}
3400 Set SPEED_COEFF and SPEED_OFFSET for delay calculations. If unspecified
3401 speed_coeff defaults to 600000 and speed_offset defaults to 575.
3402 @end deffn
3403
3404 See @file{interface/beaglebone-swd-native.cfg} for a sample configuration file.
3405
3406 @end deffn
3407
3408
3409 @deffn {Interface Driver} {linuxgpiod}
3410 Linux provides userspace access to GPIO through libgpiod since Linux kernel
3411 version v4.6. The driver emulates either JTAG or SWD transport through
3412 bitbanging. There are no driver-specific commands, all GPIO configuration is
3413 handled by the generic command @ref{adapter gpio, @command{adapter gpio}}. This
3414 driver supports the resistor pull options provided by the @command{adapter gpio}
3415 command but the underlying hardware may not be able to support them.
3416
3417 See @file{interface/dln-2-gpiod.cfg} for a sample configuration file.
3418 @end deffn
3419
3420
3421 @deffn {Interface Driver} {sysfsgpio}
3422 Linux legacy userspace access to GPIO through sysfs is deprecated from Linux kernel version v5.3.
3423 Prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}, instead.
3424
3425 See @file{interface/sysfsgpio-raspberrypi.cfg} for a sample config.
3426 @end deffn
3427
3428
3429 @deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
3430 OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
3431 This defines some driver-specific commands:
3432
3433 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag variant} variant
3434 Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
3435 Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
3436
3437 @itemize @minus
3438 @item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
3439 @item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
3440 (see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
3441 @end itemize
3442 @end deffn
3443
3444 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag device_desc} string
3445 The USB device description string of the adapter.
3446 This value is only used with the standard variant.
3447 @end deffn
3448 @end deffn
3449
3450
3451 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vdebug}
3452 Cadence Virtual Debug Interface driver.
3453
3454 @deffn {Config Command} {vdebug server} host:port
3455 Specifies the host and TCP port number where the vdebug server runs.
3456 @end deffn
3457
3458 @deffn {Config Command} {vdebug batching} value
3459 Specifies the batching method for the vdebug request. Possible values are
3460 0 for no batching
3461 1 or wr to batch write transactions together (default)
3462 2 or rw to batch both read and write transactions
3463 @end deffn
3464
3465 @deffn {Config Command} {vdebug polling} min max
3466 Takes two values, representing the polling interval in ms. Lower values mean faster
3467 debugger responsiveness, but lower emulation performance. The minimum should be
3468 around 10, maximum should not exceed 1000, which is the default gdb and keepalive
3469 timeout value.
3470 @end deffn
3471
3472 @deffn {Config Command} {vdebug bfm_path} path clk_period
3473 Specifies the hierarchical path and input clk period of the vdebug BFM in the design.
3474 The hierarchical path uses Verilog notation top.inst.inst
3475 The clock period must include the unit, for instance 40ns.
3476 @end deffn
3477
3478 @deffn {Config Command} {vdebug mem_path} path base size
3479 Specifies the hierarchical path to the design memory instance for backdoor access.
3480 Up to 4 memories can be specified. The hierarchical path uses Verilog notation.
3481 The base specifies start address in the design address space, size its size in bytes.
3482 Both values can use hexadecimal notation with prefix 0x.
3483 @end deffn
3484 @end deffn
3485
3486 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jtag_dpi}
3487 SystemVerilog Direct Programming Interface (DPI) compatible driver for
3488 JTAG devices in emulation. The driver acts as a client for the SystemVerilog
3489 DPI server interface.
3490
3491 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi set_port} port
3492 Specifies the TCP/IP port number of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3493 @end deffn
3494
3495 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi set_address} address
3496 Specifies the TCP/IP address of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3497 @end deffn
3498 @end deffn
3499
3500
3501 @deffn {Interface Driver} {buspirate}
3502
3503 This driver is for the Bus Pirate (see @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/docs/Bus_Pirate}) and compatible devices.
3504 It uses a simple data protocol over a serial port connection.
3505
3506 Most hardware development boards have a UART, a real serial port, or a virtual USB serial device, so this driver
3507 allows you to start building your own JTAG adapter without the complexity of a custom USB connection.
3508
3509 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate port} serial_port
3510 Specify the serial port's filename. For example:
3511 @example
3512 buspirate port /dev/ttyUSB0
3513 @end example
3514 @end deffn
3515
3516 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate speed} (normal|fast)
3517 Set the communication speed to 115k (normal) or 1M (fast). For example:
3518 @example
3519 buspirate speed normal
3520 @end example
3521 @end deffn
3522
3523 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate mode} (normal|open-drain)
3524 Set the Bus Pirate output mode.
3525 @itemize @minus
3526 @item In normal mode (push/pull), do not enable the pull-ups, and do not connect I/O header pin VPU to JTAG VREF.
3527 @item In open drain mode, you will then need to enable the pull-ups.
3528 @end itemize
3529 For example:
3530 @example
3531 buspirate mode normal
3532 @end example
3533 @end deffn
3534
3535 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate pullup} (0|1)
3536 Whether to connect (1) or not (0) the I/O header pin VPU (JTAG VREF)
3537 to the pull-up/pull-down resistors on MOSI (JTAG TDI), CLK (JTAG TCK), MISO (JTAG TDO) and CS (JTAG TMS).
3538 For example:
3539 @example
3540 buspirate pullup 0
3541 @end example
3542 @end deffn
3543
3544 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate vreg} (0|1)
3545 Whether to enable (1) or disable (0) the built-in voltage regulator,
3546 which can be used to supply power to a test circuit through
3547 I/O header pins +3V3 and +5V. For example:
3548 @example
3549 buspirate vreg 0
3550 @end example
3551 @end deffn
3552
3553 @deffn {Command} {buspirate led} (0|1)
3554 Turns the Bus Pirate's LED on (1) or off (0). For example:
3555 @end deffn
3556 @example
3557 buspirate led 1
3558 @end example
3559
3560 @end deffn
3561
3562 @deffn {Interface Driver} {esp_usb_jtag}
3563 Espressif JTAG driver to communicate with ESP32-C3, ESP32-S3 chips and ESP USB Bridge board using OpenOCD.
3564 These chips have built-in JTAG circuitry and can be debugged without any additional hardware.
3565 Only an USB cable connected to the D+/D- pins is necessary.
3566
3567 @deffn {Command} {espusbjtag tdo}
3568 Returns the current state of the TDO line
3569 @end deffn
3570
3571 @deffn {Command} {espusbjtag setio} setio
3572 Manually set the status of the output lines with the order of (tdi tms tck trst srst)
3573 @example
3574 espusbjtag setio 0 1 0 1 0
3575 @end example
3576 @end deffn
3577
3578 @deffn {Config Command} {espusbjtag vid_pid} vid_pid
3579 Set vendor ID and product ID for the ESP usb jtag driver
3580 @example
3581 espusbjtag vid_pid 0x303a 0x1001
3582 @end example
3583 @end deffn
3584
3585 @deffn {Config Command} {espusbjtag caps_descriptor} caps_descriptor
3586 Set the jtag descriptor to read capabilities of ESP usb jtag driver
3587 @example
3588 espusbjtag caps_descriptor 0x2000
3589 @end example
3590 @end deffn
3591
3592 @deffn {Config Command} {espusbjtag chip_id} chip_id
3593 Set chip id to transfer to the ESP USB bridge board
3594 @example
3595 espusbjtag chip_id 1
3596 @end example
3597 @end deffn
3598
3599 @end deffn
3600
3601 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dmem} Direct Memory access debug interface
3602
3603 The Texas Instruments K3 SoC family provides memory access to DAP
3604 and coresight control registers. This allows control over the
3605 microcontrollers directly from one of the processors on the SOC
3606 itself.
3607
3608 For maximum performance, the driver accesses the debug registers
3609 directly over the SoC memory map. The memory mapping requires read
3610 and write permission to kernel memory via "/dev/mem" and assumes that
3611 the system firewall configurations permit direct access to the debug
3612 memory space.
3613
3614 @verbatim
3615 +-----------+
3616 | OpenOCD | SoC mem map (/dev/mem)
3617 | on +--------------+
3618 | Cortex-A53| |
3619 +-----------+ |
3620 |
3621 +-----------+ +-----v-----+
3622 |Cortex-M4F <--------+ |
3623 +-----------+ | |
3624 | DebugSS |
3625 +-----------+ | |
3626 |Cortex-M4F <--------+ |
3627 +-----------+ +-----------+
3628 @end verbatim
3629
3630 NOTE: Firewalls are configurable in K3 SoC and depending on various types of
3631 device configuration, this function may be blocked out. Typical behavior
3632 observed in such cases is a firewall exception report on the security
3633 controller and armv8 processor reporting a system error.
3634
3635 See @file{tcl/interface/ti_k3_am625-swd-native.cfg} for a sample configuration
3636 file.
3637
3638 @deffn {Command} {dmem info}
3639 Print the DAPBUS dmem configuration.
3640 @end deffn
3641
3642 @deffn {Config Command} {dmem device} device_path
3643 Set the DAPBUS memory access device (default: /dev/mem).
3644 @end deffn
3645
3646 @deffn {Config Command} {dmem base_address} base_address
3647 Set the DAPBUS base address which is used to access CoreSight
3648 compliant Access Ports (APs) directly.
3649 @end deffn
3650
3651 @deffn {Config Command} {dmem ap_address_offset} offset_address
3652 Set the address offset between Access Ports (APs).
3653 @end deffn
3654
3655 @deffn {Config Command} {dmem max_aps} n
3656 Set the maximum number of valid access ports on the SoC.
3657 @end deffn
3658
3659 @deffn {Config Command} {dmem emu_ap_list} n
3660 Set the list of Access Ports (APs) that need to be emulated. This
3661 emulation mode supports software translation of an AP request into an
3662 address mapped transaction that does not rely on physical AP hardware.
3663 This maybe needed if the AP is either denied access via memory map or
3664 protected using other SoC mechanisms.
3665 @end deffn
3666
3667 @deffn {Config Command} {dmem emu_base_address_range} base_address address_window_size
3668 Set the emulated address and address window size. Both of these
3669 parameters must be aligned to page size.
3670 @end deffn
3671
3672 @end deffn
3673
3674 @section Transport Configuration
3675 @cindex Transport
3676 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3677 and the debug adapter you are using,
3678 several transports may be available to
3679 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3680 @deffn {Command} {transport list}
3681 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3682 version of OpenOCD.
3683 @end deffn
3684
3685 @deffn {Command} {transport select} @option{transport_name}
3686 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3687
3688 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
3689 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
3690 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
3691 adapter's driver).
3692
3693 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3694 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3695 supported by the debug adapter.
3696
3697 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3698 transport, if any.
3699 @end deffn
3700
3701 @subsection JTAG Transport
3702 @cindex JTAG
3703 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3704 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3705 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3706 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3707 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3708 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3709
3710 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3711 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3712 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_jtag})
3713 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3714 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_jtag}).
3715
3716 @subsection SWD Transport
3717 @cindex SWD
3718 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3719 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3720 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3721 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3722 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3723 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3724 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3725
3726 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3727 swd}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3728 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_swd})
3729 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3730 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_swd}).
3731
3732 @deffn {Config Command} {swd newdap} ...
3733 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3734 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3735 expected to change.
3736 @end deffn
3737
3738 @cindex SWD multi-drop
3739 The newer SWD devices (SW-DP v2 or SWJ-DP v2) support the multi-drop extension
3740 of SWD protocol: two or more devices can be connected to one SWD adapter.
3741 SWD transport works in multi-drop mode if @ref{dap_create,DAP} is configured
3742 with both @code{-dp-id} and @code{-instance-id} parameters regardless how many
3743 DAPs are created.
3744
3745 Not all adapters and adapter drivers support SWD multi-drop. Only the following
3746 adapter drivers are SWD multi-drop capable:
3747 cmsis_dap (use an adapter with CMSIS-DAP version 2.0), ftdi, all bitbang based.
3748
3749 @subsection SPI Transport
3750 @cindex SPI
3751 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3752 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3753 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3754 solution for flash programming.
3755
3756 @anchor{swimtransport}
3757 @subsection SWIM Transport
3758 @cindex SWIM
3759 @cindex Single Wire Interface Module
3760 The Single Wire Interface Module (SWIM) is a low-pin-count debug protocol used
3761 by the STMicroelectronics MCU family STM8 and documented in the
3762 @uref{https://www.st.com/resource/en/user_manual/cd00173911.pdf, User Manual UM470}.
3763
3764 SWIM does not support boundary scan testing nor multiple cores.
3765
3766 The SWIM transport is selected with the command @command{transport select swim}.
3767
3768 The concept of TAPs does not fit in the protocol since SWIM does not implement
3769 a scan chain. Nevertheless, the current SW model of OpenOCD requires defining a
3770 virtual SWIM TAP through the command @command{swim newtap basename tap_type}.
3771 The TAP definition must precede the target definition command
3772 @command{target create target_name stm8 -chain-position basename.tap_type}.
3773
3774 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3775 @section JTAG Speed
3776 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3777 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3778 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3779 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3780 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3781 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3782 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3783 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3784 power management software that may be active.
3785
3786 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3787 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3788 target event handler.
3789 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3790 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3791 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3792 sets up those clocks).
3793 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3794 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3795 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3796 in the target config file.
3797 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3798 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3799 config file instead.
3800 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3801 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3802 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3803
3804 @example
3805 jtag_rclk 3000
3806 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3807 @end example
3808
3809 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3810 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3811 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3812 may not be the fastest solution.
3813
3814 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3815 instead of @command{adapter speed}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3816 which support adaptive clocking.
3817
3818 @deffn {Command} {adapter speed} max_speed_kHz
3819 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3820 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3821 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3822 than the speed specified.
3823
3824 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3825 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3826 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3827 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3828
3829 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3830 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3831 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3832 JTAG clocking after setup.
3833 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3834 If the interface device can not
3835 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3836 @end deffn
3837
3838 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3839 @cindex adaptive clocking
3840 @cindex RTCK
3841 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3842 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3843 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3844 @example
3845 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3846 jtag_rclk 3000
3847 @end example
3848 @end defun
3849
3850 @node Reset Configuration
3851 @chapter Reset Configuration
3852 @cindex Reset Configuration
3853
3854 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3855 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3856 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3857 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3858 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3859 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3860 Please see the various board files for examples.
3861
3862 @quotation Note
3863 To maintainers and integrators:
3864 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3865 Normally the board configuration file
3866 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3867 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3868
3869 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3870 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3871 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3872 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3873 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3874 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3875 @end quotation
3876
3877 @section Types of Reset
3878
3879 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3880 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3881 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3882
3883 @itemize @bullet
3884 @item
3885 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3886 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3887 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3888 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3889 @item
3890 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3891 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3892 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3893 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3894 @item
3895 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3896 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3897 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3898 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3899 @item
3900 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3901 several other types of reset.
3902 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3903 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3904 There may be individual module resets.
3905 @end itemize
3906
3907 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3908 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3909 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3910 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3911 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3912 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3913 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3914 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3915 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3916
3917 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3918 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3919
3920 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3921 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3922 common issues are:
3923
3924 @itemize @bullet
3925
3926 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3927 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3928 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3929 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3930 when either of those signals is not connected.
3931 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3932 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3933 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3934 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3935
3936 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3937 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3938 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3939 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3940
3941 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3942 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3943 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3944 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3945 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3946 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3947 hardware debouncing.
3948 Use the @command{adapter srst delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3949 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3950
3951 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3952 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3953 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3954 to use push/pull output drivers.
3955 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3956 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3957 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3958 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3959
3960 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3961 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3962 issues (not limited to errata).
3963 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3964 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3965 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3966 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3967 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3968 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3969 @end itemize
3970
3971 There can also be other issues.
3972 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3973 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3974 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3975 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3976 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3977 Agreement (NDA).
3978
3979 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3980 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3981 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3982
3983 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3984 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3985
3986 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3987
3988 @deffn {Command} {adapter srst pulse_width} milliseconds
3989 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3990 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3991 allowing it to be deasserted.
3992 @end deffn
3993
3994 @deffn {Command} {adapter srst delay} milliseconds
3995 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3996 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3997 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3998 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3999 @end deffn
4000
4001 @deffn {Command} {jtag_ntrst_assert_width} milliseconds
4002 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
4003 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
4004 allowing it to be deasserted.
4005 @end deffn
4006
4007 @deffn {Command} {jtag_ntrst_delay} milliseconds
4008 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
4009 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
4010 @end deffn
4011
4012 @anchor{reset_config}
4013 @deffn {Command} {reset_config} mode_flag ...
4014 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
4015 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
4016 configuration scripts.
4017
4018 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
4019 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
4020 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
4021 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
4022 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
4023 from a particular combination of interface and board.
4024 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
4025 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
4026
4027 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
4028 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
4029 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
4030 -- may be specified at a time.
4031 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
4032 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
4033 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
4034 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
4035 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
4036
4037 @itemize
4038 @item
4039 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
4040 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
4041 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
4042 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
4043 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
4044
4045 @quotation Tip
4046 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
4047 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
4048 @end quotation
4049
4050 @item
4051 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
4052 signal implementations.
4053 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
4054 indicating everything behaves normally.
4055 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
4056 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
4057 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
4058 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
4059 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
4060 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
4061 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
4062
4063 @item
4064 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
4065 JTAG may be unavailable during reset.
4066 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
4067 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
4068 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
4069 while SRST is asserted.
4070 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
4071 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
4072
4073 @item
4074 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
4075 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
4076 is required to use this option.
4077 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
4078 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
4079 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
4080 be asserted before any target connection.
4081 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
4082 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
4083 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
4084 @end itemize
4085
4086 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
4087 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
4088 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
4089 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
4090 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
4091
4092 @itemize
4093 @item
4094 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
4095 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
4096 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
4097 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
4098
4099 @item
4100 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
4101 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
4102 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
4103 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
4104 power-up and pressing a reset button.
4105 @end itemize
4106 @end deffn
4107
4108 @section Custom Reset Handling
4109 @cindex events
4110
4111 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
4112 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
4113 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
4114 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
4115 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
4116 at particular points in the reset sequence.
4117
4118 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
4119 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
4120 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
4121 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
4122 want to reset everything at once.
4123
4124 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
4125 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
4126 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
4127 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
4128 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
4129 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
4130 needs special attention.
4131
4132 Experiment with lower level operations, such as
4133 @command{adapter assert}, @command{adapter deassert}
4134 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
4135 to find a sequence of operations that works.
4136 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
4137 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
4138 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
4139 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
4140 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
4141
4142 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
4143 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
4144 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
4145 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
4146 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
4147
4148 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} {init_reset} mode
4149 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
4150 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
4151 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
4152 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
4153 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
4154 low level reset command (@option{halt},
4155 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
4156 or potentially some other value.
4157
4158 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
4159 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
4160 operations such as @command{adapter assert} and @command{adapter deassert}.
4161 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
4162 (or their associated targets)
4163 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
4164
4165 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
4166 they return.
4167 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
4168 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
4169 @end deffn
4170
4171 @deffn {Command} {jtag arp_init}
4172 This validates the scan chain using just the four
4173 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
4174 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
4175 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
4176 matches the TAPs it can observe.
4177 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
4178 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
4179 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
4180 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
4181 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
4182 @end deffn
4183
4184 @deffn {Command} {jtag arp_init-reset}
4185 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
4186 everything on the JTAG scan chain
4187 (and anything else connected to SRST).
4188 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
4189 @end deffn
4190
4191
4192 @node TAP Declaration
4193 @chapter TAP Declaration
4194 @cindex TAP declaration
4195 @cindex TAP configuration
4196
4197 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
4198 TAPs serve many roles, including:
4199
4200 @itemize @bullet
4201 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
4202 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
4203 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
4204 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
4205 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
4206 start running that code.
4207 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
4208 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
4209 and missing connections.
4210 @end itemize
4211
4212 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
4213 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
4214 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
4215 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
4216 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
4217
4218 @section Scan Chains
4219 @cindex scan chain
4220
4221 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
4222 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
4223 They also need to be added to
4224 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
4225 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
4226 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
4227 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
4228 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
4229 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
4230 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
4231 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
4232
4233 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
4234 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
4235 command, presented in the next chapter.
4236 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
4237 debugging targets.)
4238 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
4239
4240 @verbatim
4241 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
4242 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
4243 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
4244 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
4245 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
4246 @end verbatim
4247
4248 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
4249 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
4250 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
4251 because not all devices provide good support for that.
4252 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
4253 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
4254 until they are told to do so.
4255
4256 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
4257 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
4258 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
4259 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
4260
4261 @example
4262 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
4263 @end example
4264
4265 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
4266 by a given chip.
4267 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
4268 and so forth.
4269 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
4270 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
4271 both inside a single chip and between them.
4272 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
4273
4274 For example, the STMicroelectronics STR912 chip has
4275 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
4276 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
4277 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
4278 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
4279 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
4280 includes commands something like this:
4281
4282 @example
4283 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
4284 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
4285 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
4286 @end example
4287
4288 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
4289 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
4290 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
4291
4292 @deffn {Command} {jtag names}
4293 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
4294 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
4295 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
4296 @example
4297 foreach t [jtag names] @{
4298 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
4299 @}
4300 @end example
4301 @end deffn
4302
4303 @deffn {Command} {scan_chain}
4304 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
4305 and their status.
4306 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
4307 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
4308 but systems with a JTAG router can
4309 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
4310 @end deffn
4311
4312 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
4313 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
4314
4315 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
4316 @c (on entry to RESET state).
4317
4318 @section TAP Names
4319 @cindex dotted name
4320
4321 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
4322 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
4323 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
4324 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
4325 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
4326 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
4327 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
4328 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
4329
4330 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
4331 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
4332 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
4333
4334 @section TAP Declaration Commands
4335
4336 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
4337 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
4338 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
4339
4340 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
4341 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
4342 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
4343 overridable.
4344
4345 @cindex TAP naming convention
4346 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
4347 and should follow this convention:
4348
4349 @itemize @bullet
4350 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
4351 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
4352 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
4353 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
4354 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
4355 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
4356 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
4357 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
4358 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
4359 with a single TAP;
4360 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
4361 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
4362 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
4363 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
4364 @end itemize
4365
4366 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
4367
4368 @itemize @bullet
4369 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
4370 @*The length in bits of the
4371 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
4372 @end itemize
4373
4374 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4375
4376 @itemize @bullet
4377 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
4378 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
4379 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
4380 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
4381 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
4382 (the TAP is linked in).
4383 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
4384 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
4385 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
4386 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
4387 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
4388 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
4389 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
4390 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
4391 values that were found but not included in the list.
4392
4393 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
4394 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
4395 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
4396 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
4397 hardware to find these values.
4398 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
4399 @item @code{-ignore-version}
4400 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
4401 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
4402 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
4403 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
4404 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
4405 @item @code{-ignore-bypass}
4406 @*Specify this to ignore the 'bypass' bit of the idcode. Some vendor put
4407 an invalid idcode regarding this bit. Specify this to ignore this bit and
4408 to not consider this tap in bypass mode.
4409 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
4410 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
4411 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
4412 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
4413 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
4414 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
4415 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
4416 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
4417 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
4418 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
4419 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
4420 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
4421 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
4422 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4423 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4424 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4425 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4426 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4427 @item @code{-ir-bypass} @var{NUMBER}
4428 @*Vendor specific bypass instruction, required by some hierarchical JTAG
4429 routers where the normal BYPASS instruction bypasses the whole router and
4430 a vendor specific bypass instruction is required to access child nodes.
4431 @end itemize
4432 @end deffn
4433
4434 @section Other TAP commands
4435
4436 @deffn {Command} {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-idcode}
4437 Get the value of the IDCODE found in hardware.
4438 @end deffn
4439
4440 @deffn {Command} {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
4441 @deffnx {Command} {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
4442 At this writing this TAP attribute
4443 mechanism is limited and used mostly for event handling.
4444 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
4445 mechanism for debugger targets.)
4446 See the next section for information about the available events.
4447
4448 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
4449 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
4450 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
4451 @end deffn
4452
4453 @section TAP Events
4454 @cindex events
4455 @cindex TAP events
4456
4457 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
4458 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
4459 The other applies to debugger targets,
4460 which are associated with certain TAPs.
4461
4462 The TAP events currently defined are:
4463
4464 @itemize @bullet
4465 @item @b{post-reset}
4466 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
4467 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
4468 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
4469 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
4470 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
4471
4472 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
4473 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
4474 of any particular target.
4475 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
4476 @item @b{setup}
4477 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
4478 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
4479 @item @b{tap-disable}
4480 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
4481 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
4482 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4483 @item @b{tap-enable}
4484 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
4485 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
4486 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4487 @end itemize
4488
4489 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
4490 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
4491 contents to be accurate), you might:
4492
4493 @example
4494 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
4495 echo "JTAG Reset done"
4496 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
4497 @}
4498 @end example
4499
4500
4501 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
4502 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
4503 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
4504 @cindex jrc
4505
4506 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
4507 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
4508 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
4509 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
4510 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
4511
4512 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
4513 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
4514 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
4515 be visible.
4516 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
4517 ignores, such as:
4518
4519 @itemize
4520 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
4521 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
4522 TAPs receive new instructions.
4523 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
4524 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
4525 @end itemize
4526
4527 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
4528 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
4529 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
4530 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
4531
4532 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
4533 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
4534
4535 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
4536 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
4537 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
4538 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
4539 should define TAP event handlers using
4540 code that looks something like this:
4541
4542 @example
4543 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
4544 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4545 @}
4546 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
4547 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4548 @}
4549 @end example
4550
4551 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
4552
4553 @example
4554 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
4555 @end example
4556
4557 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
4558 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
4559 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
4560 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
4561
4562 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
4563 If necessary, disables the tap
4564 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
4565 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4566 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4567 and "0" if it is disabled.
4568 @end deffn
4569
4570 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
4571 If necessary, enables the tap
4572 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
4573 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4574 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4575 and "0" if it is disabled.
4576 @end deffn
4577
4578 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
4579 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4580 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4581 and "0" if it is disabled.
4582
4583 @quotation Note
4584 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
4585 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
4586 @end quotation
4587 @end deffn
4588
4589 @anchor{autoprobing}
4590 @section Autoprobing
4591 @cindex autoprobe
4592 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
4593
4594 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
4595 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
4596 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
4597 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
4598
4599 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
4600 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
4601 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
4602 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
4603 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
4604 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
4605 right when they come out of reset).
4606
4607 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
4608
4609 @example
4610 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
4611 reset_config trst_and_srst
4612 jtag_rclk 8
4613 @end example
4614
4615 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
4616 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
4617
4618 @enumerate
4619 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
4620 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
4621 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
4622 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
4623 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
4624 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
4625 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
4626 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
4627 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
4628 that is discovered.
4629 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
4630 register, it will report it.
4631 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
4632 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
4633 @end enumerate
4634
4635 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
4636 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
4637 that's a bit more complex:
4638
4639 @example
4640 clock speed 8 kHz
4641 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
4642 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
4643 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
4644 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
4645 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4646 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4647 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
4648 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
4649 @end example
4650
4651 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
4652 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
4653 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
4654 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
4655 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
4656 and so forth.
4657
4658 @anchor{dapdeclaration}
4659 @section DAP declaration (ARMv6-M, ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets)
4660 @cindex DAP declaration
4661
4662 Since OpenOCD version 0.11.0, the Debug Access Port (DAP) is
4663 no longer implicitly created together with the target. It must be
4664 explicitly declared using the @command{dap create} command. For all ARMv6-M, ARMv7
4665 and ARMv8 targets, the option "@option{-dap} @var{dap_name}" has to be used
4666 instead of "@option{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name}" when the target is created.
4667
4668 The @command{dap} command group supports the following sub-commands:
4669
4670 @anchor{dap_create}
4671 @deffn {Command} {dap create} dap_name @option{-chain-position} dotted.name configparams...
4672 Declare a DAP instance named @var{dap_name} linked to the JTAG tap
4673 @var{dotted.name}. This also creates a new command (@command{dap_name})
4674 which is used for various purposes including additional configuration.
4675 There can only be one DAP for each JTAG tap in the system.
4676
4677 A DAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4678
4679 @itemize @bullet
4680 @item @code{-adiv5}
4681 Specify that it's an ADIv5 DAP. This is the default if not specified.
4682 @item @code{-adiv6}
4683 Specify that it's an ADIv6 DAP.
4684 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4685 Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4686 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4687 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4688 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4689
4690 @item @code{-dp-id} @var{number}
4691 @*Debug port identification number for SWD DPv2 multidrop.
4692 The @var{number} is written to bits 0..27 of DP TARGETSEL during DP selection.
4693 To find the id number of a single connected device read DP TARGETID:
4694 @code{device.dap dpreg 0x24}
4695 Use bits 0..27 of TARGETID.
4696
4697 @item @code{-instance-id} @var{number}
4698 @*Instance identification number for SWD DPv2 multidrop.
4699 The @var{number} is written to bits 28..31 of DP TARGETSEL during DP selection.
4700 To find the instance number of a single connected device read DP DLPIDR:
4701 @code{device.dap dpreg 0x34}
4702 The instance number is in bits 28..31 of DLPIDR value.
4703 @end itemize
4704 @end deffn
4705
4706 @deffn {Command} {dap names}
4707 This command returns a list of all registered DAP objects. It it useful mainly
4708 for TCL scripting.
4709 @end deffn
4710
4711 @deffn {Command} {dap info} [@var{num}|@option{root}]
4712 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4713 defaulting to the currently selected AP of the currently selected target.
4714 On ADIv5 DAP @var{num} is the numeric index of the AP.
4715 On ADIv6 DAP @var{num} is the base address of the AP.
4716 With ADIv6 only, @option{root} specifies the root ROM table.
4717 @end deffn
4718
4719 @deffn {Command} {dap init}
4720 Initialize all registered DAPs. This command is used internally
4721 during initialization. It can be issued at any time after the
4722 initialization, too.
4723 @end deffn
4724
4725 The following commands exist as subcommands of DAP instances:
4726
4727 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name info} [@var{num}|@option{root}]
4728 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4729 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4730 On ADIv5 DAP @var{num} is the numeric index of the AP.
4731 On ADIv6 DAP @var{num} is the base address of the AP.
4732 With ADIv6 only, @option{root} specifies the root ROM table.
4733 @end deffn
4734
4735 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apid} [num]
4736 Displays ID register from AP @var{num}, defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4737 On ADIv5 DAP @var{num} is the numeric index of the AP.
4738 On ADIv6 DAP @var{num} is the base address of the AP.
4739 @end deffn
4740
4741 @anchor{DAP subcommand apreg}
4742 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apreg} ap_num reg [value]
4743 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
4744 or set a new value @var{value}.
4745 On ADIv5 DAP @var{ap_num} is the numeric index of the AP.
4746 On ADIv6 DAP @var{ap_num} is the base address of the AP.
4747 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4748 @end deffn
4749
4750 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apsel} [num]
4751 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
4752 On ADIv5 DAP @var{num} is the numeric index of the AP.
4753 On ADIv6 DAP @var{num} is the base address of the AP.
4754 @end deffn
4755
4756 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name dpreg} reg [value]
4757 Displays the content of DP register at address @var{reg}, or set it to a new
4758 value @var{value}.
4759
4760 In case of SWD, @var{reg} is a value in packed format
4761 @math{dpbanksel << 4 | addr} and assumes values 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4762 In case of JTAG it only assumes values 0, 4, 8 and 0xc.
4763
4764 @emph{Note:} Consider using @command{poll off} to avoid any disturbing
4765 background activity by OpenOCD while you are operating at such low-level.
4766 @end deffn
4767
4768 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name baseaddr} [num]
4769 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
4770 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4771 On ADIv5 DAP @var{num} is the numeric index of the AP.
4772 On ADIv6 DAP @var{num} is the base address of the AP.
4773 @end deffn
4774
4775 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name memaccess} [value]
4776 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
4777 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
4778 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
4779 @end deffn
4780
4781 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apcsw} [value [mask]]
4782 Displays or changes CSW bit pattern for MEM-AP transfers.
4783
4784 At the begin of each memory access the CSW pattern is extended (bitwise or-ed)
4785 by @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} bit-fields according to transfer requirements
4786 and the result is written to the real CSW register. All bits except dynamically
4787 updated fields @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} can be changed by changing
4788 the CSW pattern. Refer to ARM ADI v5 manual chapter 7.6.4 and appendix A
4789 for details.
4790
4791 Use @var{value} only syntax if you want to set the new CSW pattern as a whole.
4792 The example sets HPROT1 bit (required by Cortex-M) and clears the rest of
4793 the pattern:
4794 @example
4795 kx.dap apcsw 0x2000000
4796 @end example
4797
4798 If @var{mask} is also used, the CSW pattern is changed only on bit positions
4799 where the mask bit is 1. The following example sets HPROT3 (cacheable)
4800 and leaves the rest of the pattern intact. It configures memory access through
4801 DCache on Cortex-M7.
4802 @example
4803 set CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE [expr @{1 << 27@}]
4804 samv.dap apcsw $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE
4805 @end example
4806
4807 Another example clears SPROT bit and leaves the rest of pattern intact:
4808 @example
4809 set CSW_SPROT [expr @{1 << 30@}]
4810 samv.dap apcsw 0 $CSW_SPROT
4811 @end example
4812
4813 @emph{Note:} If you want to check the real value of CSW, not CSW pattern, use
4814 @code{xxx.dap apreg 0}. @xref{DAP subcommand apreg,,}.
4815
4816 @emph{Warning:} Some of the CSW bits are vital for working memory transfer.
4817 If you set a wrong CSW pattern and MEM-AP stopped working, use the following
4818 example with a proper dap name:
4819 @example
4820 xxx.dap apcsw default
4821 @end example
4822 @end deffn
4823
4824 @deffn {Config Command} {$dap_name ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
4825 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
4826 Disabled by default
4827 @end deffn
4828
4829 @deffn {Config Command} {$dap_name nu_npcx_quirks} [@option{enable}]
4830 Set/get quirks mode for Nuvoton NPCX/NPCD MCU families
4831 Disabled by default
4832 @end deffn
4833
4834 @node CPU Configuration
4835 @chapter CPU Configuration
4836 @cindex GDB target
4837
4838 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
4839 You can also access these targets without GDB
4840 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
4841 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
4842 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
4843 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
4844
4845 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
4846 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
4847
4848 @section Target List
4849 @cindex target, current
4850 @cindex target, list
4851
4852 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
4853 where each member has a name.
4854 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
4855 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
4856 (plural!) command.
4857 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
4858 look like with more than one:
4859 @verbatim
4860 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
4861 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
4862 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
4863 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
4864 @end verbatim
4865
4866 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
4867 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
4868 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
4869 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
4870 space seen by that current target.
4871 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
4872 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
4873 are examples; and there are many more.
4874
4875 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
4876
4877 @deffn {Command} {target current}
4878 Returns the name of the current target.
4879 @end deffn
4880
4881 @deffn {Command} {target names}
4882 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
4883 @example
4884 foreach t [target names] @{
4885 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
4886 @}
4887 @end example
4888 @end deffn
4889
4890 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4891 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4892
4893 @deffn {Command} {targets} [name]
4894 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4895 command names are singular.}
4896
4897 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4898 targets in a user friendly form.
4899
4900 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4901 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4902 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4903 @end deffn
4904
4905 @section Target CPU Types
4906 @cindex target type
4907 @cindex CPU type
4908
4909 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4910 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4911 when calling @command{target create}.
4912 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4913 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4914 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4915 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4916 what core-specific commands may be available
4917 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4918 and more.
4919
4920 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4921 since there's a command to list them.
4922
4923 @anchor{targettypes}
4924 @deffn {Command} {target types}
4925 Lists all supported target types.
4926 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4927
4928 @itemize @bullet
4929 @item @code{aarch64} -- this is an ARMv8-A core with an MMU.
4930 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores.
4931 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4932 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4933 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4934 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4935 @item @code{arm946e} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4936 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core.
4937 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4938 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4939 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4940 @item @code{avr32_ap7k} -- this an AVR32 core.
4941 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7-A core with an MMU.
4942 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7-M core, supporting only the
4943 compact Thumb2 instruction set. Supports also ARMv6-M and ARMv8-M cores
4944 @item @code{cortex_r4} -- this is an ARMv7-R core.
4945 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e.
4946 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4947 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4948 @item @code{dsp5680xx} -- implements Freescale's 5680x DSP.
4949 @item @code{esirisc} -- this is an EnSilica eSi-RISC core.
4950 The current implementation supports eSi-32xx cores.
4951 @item @code{esp32} -- this is an Espressif SoC with dual Xtensa cores.
4952 @item @code{esp32s2} -- this is an Espressif SoC with single Xtensa core.
4953 @item @code{esp32s3} -- this is an Espressif SoC with dual Xtensa cores.
4954 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb).
4955 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926.
4956 @item @code{hla_target} -- a Cortex-M alternative to work with HL adapters like ST-Link.
4957 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
4958 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
4959 @item @code{mem_ap} -- this is an ARM debug infrastructure Access Port without
4960 a CPU, through which bus read and write cycles can be generated; it may be
4961 useful for working with non-CPU hardware behind an AP or during development of
4962 support for new CPUs.
4963 It's possible to connect a GDB client to this target (the GDB port has to be
4964 specified, @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.), and a fake ARM core will
4965 be emulated to comply to GDB remote protocol.
4966 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core.
4967 @item @code{mips_mips64} -- a MIPS64 core.
4968 @item @code{or1k} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4969 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4970 @itemize @minus
4971 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}jtag})
4972 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4973 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4974 @end itemize
4975 And two debug interfaces cores:
4976 @itemize @minus
4977 @item @code{Advanced debug interface}
4978 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}adv_debug_sys})
4979 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface}
4980 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}dbg_interface})
4981 @end itemize
4982 @item @code{quark_d20xx} -- an Intel Quark D20xx core.
4983 @item @code{quark_x10xx} -- an Intel Quark X10xx core.
4984 @item @code{riscv} -- a RISC-V core.
4985 @item @code{stm8} -- implements an STM8 core.
4986 @item @code{testee} -- a dummy target for cases without a real CPU, e.g. CPLD.
4987 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4988 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4989 @item @code{xtensa} -- this is a generic Cadence/Tensilica Xtensa core.
4990 @end itemize
4991 @end deffn
4992
4993 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4994 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4995 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4996 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4997 licensed, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4998 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4999 reflect design generations;
5000 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, ARMv7 and ARMv8
5001 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
5002
5003 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
5004 @section Target Configuration
5005
5006 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
5007 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
5008 which is used to set up the CPU support.
5009 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
5010 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
5011
5012 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
5013 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
5014 optional parts.
5015 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
5016 command, created as part of target creation.
5017
5018 The two main things to configure after target creation are
5019 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
5020 if the board setup code overrides them later;
5021 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
5022 to be much more board-specific.
5023 The key steps you use might look something like this
5024
5025 @example
5026 dap create mychip.dap -chain-position mychip.cpu
5027 target create MyTarget cortex_m -dap mychip.dap
5028 MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
5029 MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
5030 MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
5031 @end example
5032
5033 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
5034 on-chip SRAM.
5035 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
5036 writes to target memory;
5037 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
5038 GDB memory checksumming;
5039 and more.
5040
5041 @quotation Warning
5042 On more complex chips, the work area can become
5043 inaccessible when application code
5044 (such as an operating system)
5045 enables or disables the MMU.
5046 For example, the particular MMU context used to access the virtual
5047 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
5048 easy access to other addresses needed.
5049 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
5050 @end quotation
5051
5052 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
5053 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
5054 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
5055 controllers.
5056 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
5057 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
5058 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
5059
5060 @deffn {Config Command} {target create} target_name type configparams...
5061 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
5062 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
5063 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
5064 purposes including additional configuration.
5065
5066 @itemize @bullet
5067 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
5068 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
5069 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
5070 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
5071
5072 This name is also used to create the target object command,
5073 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
5074 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
5075 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
5076 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
5077 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
5078 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
5079
5080 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} or
5081 @code{-dap @var{dap_name}} here.
5082 @end itemize
5083 @end deffn
5084
5085 @deffn {Command} {$target_name configure} configparams...
5086 The options accepted by this command may also be
5087 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
5088 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
5089 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
5090
5091 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
5092 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
5093 and changing its endianness.
5094
5095 @itemize @bullet
5096
5097 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
5098 used to access this target.
5099
5100 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access
5101 this target. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to
5102 create and manage DAP instances.
5103
5104 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
5105 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
5106
5107 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
5108 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
5109 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
5110 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
5111 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
5112 same event name assigns only one handler.
5113
5114 Current target is temporarily overridden to the event issuing target
5115 before handler code starts and switched back after handler is done.
5116
5117 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
5118 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
5119 @emph{it is not backed up.}
5120 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
5121 since performing a backup slows down operations.
5122 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
5123 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
5124
5125 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
5126 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
5127 or virtual address is being used.
5128
5129 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
5130 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
5131
5132 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
5133 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
5134 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
5135 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
5136 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
5137
5138 @anchor{rtostype}
5139 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
5140 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}, @option{none}, @option{eCos},
5141 @option{ThreadX}, @option{FreeRTOS}, @option{linux}, @option{ChibiOS},
5142 @option{embKernel}, @option{mqx}, @option{uCOS-III}, @option{nuttx},
5143 @option{RIOT}, @option{Zephyr}, @option{rtkernel}
5144 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
5145
5146 @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
5147 scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
5148 access the target for debugging.
5149
5150 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- set DAP access port for target.
5151 On ADIv5 DAP @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
5152 On ADIv6 DAP @var{ap_number} is the base address of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
5153 Use this option with systems where multiple, independent cores are connected
5154 to separate access ports of the same DAP.
5155
5156 @item @code{-cti} @var{cti_name} -- set Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) connected
5157 to the target. Currently, only the @code{aarch64} target makes use of this option,
5158 where it is a mandatory configuration for the target run control.
5159 @xref{armcrosstrigger,,ARM Cross-Trigger Interface},
5160 for instruction on how to declare and control a CTI instance.
5161
5162 @anchor{gdbportoverride}
5163 @item @code{-gdb-port} @var{number} -- see command @command{gdb_port} for the
5164 possible values of the parameter @var{number}, which are not only numeric values.
5165 Use this option to override, for this target only, the global parameter set with
5166 command @command{gdb_port}.
5167 @xref{gdb_port,,command gdb_port}.
5168
5169 @item @code{-gdb-max-connections} @var{number} -- EXPERIMENTAL: set the maximum
5170 number of GDB connections that are allowed for the target. Default is 1.
5171 A negative value for @var{number} means unlimited connections.
5172 See @xref{gdbmeminspect,,Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}.
5173 @end itemize
5174 @end deffn
5175
5176 @section Other $target_name Commands
5177 @cindex object command
5178
5179 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
5180 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
5181
5182 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
5183 Once a button is created a button
5184 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
5185 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
5186 configure it like this:
5187
5188 @example
5189 # Create
5190 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
5191 # Modify
5192 .foobar configure -foreground blue
5193 # Query
5194 set x [.foobar cget -background]
5195 # Report
5196 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
5197 @end example
5198
5199 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
5200 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
5201
5202 @example
5203 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
5204 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
5205 @end example
5206
5207 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
5208
5209 @deffn {Command} {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
5210 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_halt}
5211 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_poll}
5212 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_reset}
5213 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_waitstate}
5214 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
5215 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
5216 They are not otherwise documented here.
5217 @end deffn
5218
5219 @deffn {Command} {$target_name set_reg} dict
5220 Set register values of the target.
5221
5222 @itemize
5223 @item @var{dict} ... Tcl dictionary with pairs of register names and values.
5224 @end itemize
5225
5226 For example, the following command sets the value 0 to the program counter (pc)
5227 register and 0x1000 to the stack pointer (sp) register:
5228
5229 @example
5230 set_reg @{pc 0 sp 0x1000@}
5231 @end example
5232 @end deffn
5233
5234 @deffn {Command} {$target_name get_reg} [-force] list
5235 Get register values from the target and return them as Tcl dictionary with pairs
5236 of register names and values.
5237 If option "-force" is set, the register values are read directly from the
5238 target, bypassing any caching.
5239
5240 @itemize
5241 @item @var{list} ... List of register names
5242 @end itemize
5243
5244 For example, the following command retrieves the values from the program
5245 counter (pc) and stack pointer (sp) register:
5246
5247 @example
5248 get_reg @{pc sp@}
5249 @end example
5250 @end deffn
5251
5252 @deffn {Command} {$target_name write_memory} address width data ['phys']
5253 This function provides an efficient way to write to the target memory from a Tcl
5254 script.
5255
5256 @itemize
5257 @item @var{address} ... target memory address
5258 @item @var{width} ... memory access bit size, can be 8, 16, 32 or 64
5259 @item @var{data} ... Tcl list with the elements to write
5260 @item ['phys'] ... treat the memory address as physical instead of virtual address
5261 @end itemize
5262
5263 For example, the following command writes two 32 bit words into the target
5264 memory at address 0x20000000:
5265
5266 @example
5267 write_memory 0x20000000 32 @{0xdeadbeef 0x00230500@}
5268 @end example
5269 @end deffn
5270
5271 @deffn {Command} {$target_name read_memory} address width count ['phys']
5272 This function provides an efficient way to read the target memory from a Tcl
5273 script.
5274 A Tcl list containing the requested memory elements is returned by this function.
5275
5276 @itemize
5277 @item @var{address} ... target memory address
5278 @item @var{width} ... memory access bit size, can be 8, 16, 32 or 64
5279 @item @var{count} ... number of elements to read
5280 @item ['phys'] ... treat the memory address as physical instead of virtual address
5281 @end itemize
5282
5283 For example, the following command reads two 32 bit words from the target
5284 memory at address 0x20000000:
5285
5286 @example
5287 read_memory 0x20000000 32 2
5288 @end example
5289 @end deffn
5290
5291 @deffn {Command} {$target_name cget} queryparm
5292 Each configuration parameter accepted by
5293 @command{$target_name configure}
5294 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
5295 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
5296 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
5297 There are a few special cases:
5298
5299 @itemize @bullet
5300 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
5301 event named @var{event_name}.
5302 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
5303 two parameters.
5304 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
5305 This is a special case because this is set using
5306 @command{target create} and can't be changed
5307 using @command{$target_name configure}.
5308 @end itemize
5309
5310 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
5311 all the targets you might use something like this:
5312
5313 @example
5314 foreach name [target names] @{
5315 set y [$name cget -endian]
5316 set z [$name cget -type]
5317 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
5318 $x $name $y $z]
5319 @}
5320 @end example
5321 @end deffn
5322
5323 @anchor{targetcurstate}
5324 @deffn {Command} {$target_name curstate}
5325 Displays the current target state:
5326 @code{debug-running},
5327 @code{halted},
5328 @code{reset},
5329 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
5330 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
5331 @end deffn
5332
5333 @deffn {Command} {$target_name debug_reason}
5334 Displays the current debug reason:
5335 @code{debug-request},
5336 @code{breakpoint},
5337 @code{watchpoint},
5338 @code{watchpoint-and-breakpoint},
5339 @code{single-step},
5340 @code{target-not-halted},
5341 @code{program-exit},
5342 @code{exception-catch} or @code{undefined}.
5343 @end deffn
5344
5345 @deffn {Command} {$target_name eventlist}
5346 Displays a table listing all event handlers
5347 currently associated with this target.
5348 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
5349 @end deffn
5350
5351 @deffn {Command} {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
5352 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
5353 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
5354 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
5355 @end deffn
5356
5357 @deffn {Command} {$target_name mdd} [phys] addr [count]
5358 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdw} [phys] addr [count]
5359 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdh} [phys] addr [count]
5360 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdb} [phys] addr [count]
5361 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
5362 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
5363 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
5364 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
5365 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
5366 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
5367 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
5368 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
5369 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
5370 (If you want to process the data instead of displaying it,
5371 see the @code{read_memory} primitives.)
5372 @end deffn
5373
5374 @deffn {Command} {$target_name mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
5375 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mww} [phys] addr word [count]
5376 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
5377 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
5378 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
5379 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
5380 at the specified address @var{addr}.
5381 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
5382 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
5383 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
5384 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
5385 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
5386 @end deffn
5387
5388 @anchor{targetevents}
5389 @section Target Events
5390 @cindex target events
5391 @cindex events
5392 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
5393 For example:
5394 @itemize @bullet
5395 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
5396 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
5397 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
5398 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
5399 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
5400 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
5401 to set up system clocks or
5402 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
5403 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
5404 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
5405 @end itemize
5406
5407 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
5408 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
5409 @command{target create ... -event}.
5410
5411 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
5412 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
5413 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
5414
5415 @example
5416 proc my_init_proc @{ @} @{
5417 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
5418 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
5419 @}
5420 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init my_init_proc
5421 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init @{
5422 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
5423 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
5424 @}
5425 @end example
5426
5427 The following target events are defined:
5428
5429 @itemize @bullet
5430 @item @b{debug-halted}
5431 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
5432 @item @b{debug-resumed}
5433 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: GDB said run)
5434 @item @b{early-halted}
5435 @* Occurs early in the halt process
5436 @item @b{examine-start}
5437 @* Before target examine is called.
5438 @item @b{examine-end}
5439 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
5440 @item @b{examine-fail}
5441 @* After target examine fails.
5442 @item @b{gdb-attach}
5443 @* When GDB connects. Issued before any GDB communication with the target
5444 starts. GDB expects the target is halted during attachment.
5445 @xref{gdbmeminspect,,GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}, how to
5446 connect GDB to running target.
5447 The event can be also used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash.
5448 Probing flash is necessary during GDB connect if you want to use
5449 @pxref{programmingusinggdb,,programming using GDB}.
5450 Another use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically choose
5451 hardware or software breakpoints depending on whether the breakpoint
5452 is in RAM or read only memory.
5453 Default is @code{halt}
5454 @item @b{gdb-detach}
5455 @* When GDB disconnects
5456 @item @b{gdb-end}
5457 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
5458 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
5459 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
5460 @code{reset init})
5461 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
5462 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
5463 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
5464 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
5465 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
5466 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
5467 @item @b{gdb-start}
5468 @* Before the target steps, GDB is trying to start/resume the target
5469 @item @b{halted}
5470 @* The target has halted
5471 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
5472 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5473 after @command{reset-start} was triggered
5474 but before either SRST alone is asserted on the scan chain,
5475 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
5476 @item @b{reset-assert}
5477 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5478 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
5479 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
5480 it instead of asserting SRST.
5481 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
5482 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
5483 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
5484 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
5485 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5486 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
5487 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
5488 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
5489 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5490 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
5491 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
5492 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5493 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
5494 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
5495 released on the scan chain.
5496 @item @b{reset-end}
5497 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
5498 @item @b{reset-init}
5499 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
5500 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
5501
5502 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
5503 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
5504 multiplexing, and so on.
5505 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
5506 the target clocks are fully set up.)
5507 @item @b{reset-start}
5508 @* Issued as the first step in @command{reset} processing
5509 before @command{reset-assert-pre} is called.
5510
5511 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
5512 or @command{adapter speed} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
5513 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
5514 @item @b{resume-start}
5515 @* Before any target is resumed
5516 @item @b{resume-end}
5517 @* After all targets have resumed
5518 @item @b{resumed}
5519 @* Target has resumed
5520 @item @b{step-start}
5521 @* Before a target is single-stepped
5522 @item @b{step-end}
5523 @* After single-step has completed
5524 @item @b{trace-config}
5525 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
5526 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x100}
5527 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x100
5528 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x101}
5529 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x101
5530 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x102}
5531 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x102
5532 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x103}
5533 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x103
5534 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x104}
5535 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x104
5536 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x105}
5537 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x105
5538 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x106}
5539 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x106
5540 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x107}
5541 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x107
5542 @end itemize
5543
5544 @quotation Note
5545 OpenOCD events are not supposed to be preempt by another event, but this
5546 is not enforced in current code. Only the target event @b{resumed} is
5547 executed with polling disabled; this avoids polling to trigger the event
5548 @b{halted}, reversing the logical order of execution of their handlers.
5549 Future versions of OpenOCD will prevent the event preemption and will
5550 disable the schedule of polling during the event execution. Do not rely
5551 on polling in any event handler; this means, don't expect the status of
5552 a core to change during the execution of the handler. The event handler
5553 will have to enable polling or use @command{$target_name arp_poll} to
5554 check if the core has changed status.
5555 @end quotation
5556
5557 @node Flash Commands
5558 @chapter Flash Commands
5559
5560 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
5561 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
5562 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
5563 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
5564 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
5565 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
5566 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
5567 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
5568 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
5569
5570 Flash Steps:
5571 @enumerate
5572 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
5573 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
5574 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
5575 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
5576 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
5577 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
5578 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
5579 @item GDB Flashing
5580 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
5581 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
5582 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
5583 @end enumerate
5584
5585 Many CPUs have the ability to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
5586 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
5587 so that it can't boot.
5588 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
5589 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
5590
5591 @anchor{norconfiguration}
5592 @section Flash Configuration Commands
5593 @cindex flash configuration
5594
5595 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
5596 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
5597 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
5598 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
5599 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
5600 see the driver-specific documentation.
5601
5602 @itemize @bullet
5603 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
5604 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
5605 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
5606 associated with the flash bank being declared.
5607 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
5608 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
5609 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
5610 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
5611 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
5612 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
5613 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
5614 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5615 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
5616 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5617 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
5618 commands to the flash controller.
5619 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
5620 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
5621 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
5622 for more information.
5623 @end itemize
5624 @quotation Note
5625 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
5626 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
5627 @end quotation
5628 @end deffn
5629
5630 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
5631 @deffn {Command} {flash banks}
5632 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
5633 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5634 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
5635 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
5636 @end deffn
5637
5638 @deffn {Command} {flash list}
5639 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
5640 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5641 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
5642 @end deffn
5643
5644 @deffn {Command} {flash probe} num
5645 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
5646 depends on the flash type.
5647 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5648 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
5649 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
5650 but most don't bother.
5651 @end deffn
5652
5653 @section Preparing a Target before Flash Programming
5654
5655 The target device should be in well defined state before the flash programming
5656 begins.
5657
5658 @emph{Always issue} @command{reset init} before @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
5659 Do not issue another @command{reset} or @command{reset halt} or @command{resume}
5660 until the programming session is finished.
5661
5662 If you use @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
5663 the target is prepared automatically in the event gdb-flash-erase-start
5664
5665 The jimtcl script @command{program} calls @command{reset init} explicitly.
5666
5667 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
5668 @cindex flash erasing
5669 @cindex flash reading
5670 @cindex flash writing
5671 @cindex flash programming
5672 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
5673
5674 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
5675 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressable memory.
5676 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
5677 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
5678 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
5679
5680 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
5681 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
5682 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
5683 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
5684 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
5685
5686 @quotation Note
5687 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
5688 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
5689 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
5690 back to a flash bank.
5691 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
5692 @comment with that target doesn't successfully autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
5693 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
5694 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
5695 Avoid confusing the two command models.
5696 @end quotation
5697
5698 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
5699 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
5700 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
5701 disabled first.
5702 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
5703 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
5704 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
5705
5706 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_sector} num first last
5707 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
5708 up to and including @var{last}.
5709 Sector numbering starts at 0.
5710 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
5711 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5712 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5713 @end deffn
5714
5715 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
5716 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
5717 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
5718 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
5719 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
5720 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
5721 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
5722 the specified length must stay within that bank.
5723 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
5724 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
5725 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
5726 before erase starts.
5727 @end deffn
5728
5729 @deffn {Command} {flash filld} address double-word length
5730 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillw} address word length
5731 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillh} address halfword length
5732 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillb} address byte length
5733 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{double-word} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
5734 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
5735 starting at @var{address} and continuing
5736 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
5737 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
5738 before issuing this command.
5739 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
5740 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
5741 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5742 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5743 @end deffn
5744 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
5745
5746 @deffn {Command} {flash mdw} addr [count]
5747 @deffnx {Command} {flash mdh} addr [count]
5748 @deffnx {Command} {flash mdb} addr [count]
5749 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
5750 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
5751 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
5752 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
5753 Reads from flash using the flash driver, therefore it enables reading
5754 from a bank not mapped in target address space.
5755 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5756 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5757 @end deffn
5758
5759 @deffn {Command} {flash write_bank} num filename [offset]
5760 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
5761 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank. If @var{offset}
5762 is omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank.
5763 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5764 @end deffn
5765
5766 @deffn {Command} {flash read_bank} num filename [offset [length]]
5767 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
5768 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}. If @var{offset} is
5769 omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank. If @var{length} is omitted,
5770 read the remaining bytes from the flash bank.
5771 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5772 @end deffn
5773
5774 @deffn {Command} {flash verify_bank} num filename [offset]
5775 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
5776 flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. If @var{offset} is omitted,
5777 start at the beginning of the flash bank. Fail if the contents do not match.
5778 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5779 @end deffn
5780
5781 @deffn {Command} {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
5782 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5783 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
5784 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
5785 to the base address for each section in the image.
5786 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
5787 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
5788 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
5789 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
5790 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
5791 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
5792 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
5793 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
5794 each image section.
5795
5796 @quotation Warning
5797 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
5798 data you want to preserve.
5799 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
5800 sections might be erased with no notice.
5801 @itemize
5802 @item
5803 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
5804 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
5805 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
5806 @item
5807 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
5808 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
5809 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
5810 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
5811 @end itemize
5812 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
5813 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
5814 @end quotation
5815
5816 @end deffn
5817
5818 @deffn {Command} {flash verify_image} filename [offset] [type]
5819 Verify the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5820 Parameters follow the description of 'flash write_image'.
5821 In contrast to the 'verify_image' command, for banks with specific
5822 verify method, that one is used instead of the usual target's read
5823 memory methods. This is necessary for flash banks not readable by
5824 ordinary memory reads.
5825 This command gives only an overall good/bad result for each bank, not
5826 addresses of individual failed bytes as it's intended only as quick
5827 check for successful programming.
5828 @end deffn
5829
5830 @section Other Flash commands
5831 @cindex flash protection
5832
5833 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_check} num
5834 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
5835 and display that status.
5836 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5837 @end deffn
5838
5839 @deffn {Command} {flash info} num [sectors]
5840 Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
5841 and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
5842
5843 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5844 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
5845 and possibly stale information.
5846 @end deffn
5847
5848 @anchor{flashprotect}
5849 @deffn {Command} {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
5850 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash blocks
5851 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at protection block @var{first}
5852 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
5853 Providing a @var{last} block of @option{last}
5854 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5855 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5856 The protection block is usually identical to a flash sector.
5857 Some devices may utilize a protection block distinct from flash sector.
5858 See @command{flash info} for a list of protection blocks.
5859 @end deffn
5860
5861 @deffn {Command} {flash padded_value} num value
5862 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
5863 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
5864 command or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
5865 @end deffn
5866
5867 @anchor{program}
5868 @deffn {Command} {program} filename [preverify] [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
5869 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
5870 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
5871 @xref{Flash Programming}.
5872 @end deffn
5873
5874 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
5875 @section Flash Driver List
5876 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
5877 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
5878 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
5879
5880 @deffn {Flash Driver} {virtual}
5881 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
5882 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
5883
5884 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
5885
5886 @itemize
5887 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
5888 @end itemize
5889
5890 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
5891 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any command executed on
5892 the virtual banks is actually performed on the physical banks.
5893 @example
5894 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5895 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 \
5896 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5897 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 \
5898 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5899 @end example
5900 @end deffn
5901
5902 @subsection External Flash
5903
5904 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cfi}
5905 @cindex Common Flash Interface
5906 @cindex CFI
5907 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
5908 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
5909 specific external chip select on the CPU.
5910 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
5911 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
5912 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
5913 configure a bus and its timings), or
5914 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
5915 on the flash chip.
5916 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
5917 speed up operation.
5918
5919 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
5920
5921 @itemize
5922 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
5923 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
5924 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
5925 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
5926 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
5927 swapped when writing data values (i.e. not CFI commands).
5928 @end itemize
5929
5930 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
5931 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
5932
5933 @example
5934 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5935 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5936 @end example
5937
5938 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
5939 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
5940 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
5941
5942 @example
5943 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
5944 @end example
5945
5946 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
5947 @end deffn
5948
5949 @anchor{jtagspi}
5950 @deffn {Flash Driver} {jtagspi}
5951 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
5952 @cindex SPI
5953 @cindex jtagspi
5954 @cindex bscan_spi
5955 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
5956 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, some FPGA
5957 device provides dedicated JTAG instructions, while other FPGA devices should
5958 be programmed with a special proxy bitstream that exposes the SPI flash on
5959 the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be accessed through JTAG.
5960
5961 Since signalling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
5962 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
5963 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR.
5964
5965 Such a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
5966 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires
5967 @uref{https://github.com/m-labs/migen, migen} and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
5968
5969 This mechanism with a proxy bitstream can also be used for FPGAs from Intel and
5970 Efinix. FPGAs from Lattice and Cologne Chip have dedicated JTAG instructions
5971 and procedure to connect the JTAG to the SPI signals and don't need a proxy
5972 bitstream. Support for these devices with dedicated procedure is provided by
5973 the pld drivers. For convenience the PLD drivers will provide the USERx code
5974 for FPGAs with a proxy bitstream. Currently the following PLD drivers are able
5975 to support jtagspi:
5976 @itemize
5977 @item Efinix: proxy-bitstream
5978 @item Gatemate: dedicated procedure
5979 @item Intel/Altera: proxy-bitstream
5980 @item Lattice: dedicated procedure supporting ECP2, ECP3, ECP5, Certus and Certus Pro devices
5981 @item AMD/Xilinx: proxy-bitstream
5982 @end itemize
5983
5984
5985 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
5986 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
5987 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
5988 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
5989 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
5990 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
5991 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
5992 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
5993
5994 According to device size, 1- to 4-byte addresses are sent. However, some
5995 flash chips additionally have to be switched to 4-byte addresses by an extra
5996 command, see below.
5997
5998 @itemize
5999 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
6000 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
6001 @var{USER1} instruction.
6002 @example
6003 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.tap
6004 set _USER1_INSTR_CODE 0x02
6005 flash bank $_FLASHNAME jtagspi 0x0 0 0 0 \
6006 $_TARGETNAME $_USER1_INSTR_CODE
6007 @end example
6008
6009 @item The option @option{-pld} @var{name} is used to have support from the
6010 PLD driver of pld device @var{name}. The name is the name of the pld device
6011 given during creation of the pld device.
6012 Pld device names are shown by the @command{pld devices} command.
6013
6014 @example
6015 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.tap
6016 set _JTAGSPI_CHAIN_ID $_CHIPNAME.pld
6017 flash bank $_FLASHNAME jtagspi 0x0 0 0 0 \
6018 $_TARGETNAME -pld $_JTAGSPI_CHAIN_ID
6019 @end example
6020 @end itemize
6021
6022 @deffn Command {jtagspi set} bank_id name total_size page_size read_cmd unused pprg_cmd mass_erase_cmd sector_size sector_erase_cmd
6023 Sets flash parameters: @var{name} human readable string, @var{total_size}
6024 size in bytes, @var{page_size} is write page size. @var{read_cmd} and @var{pprg_cmd}
6025 are commands for read and page program, respectively. @var{mass_erase_cmd},
6026 @var{sector_size} and @var{sector_erase_cmd} are optional.
6027 @example
6028 jtagspi set 0 w25q128 0x1000000 0x100 0x03 0 0x02 0xC7 0x10000 0xD8
6029 @end example
6030 @end deffn
6031
6032 @deffn Command {jtagspi cmd} bank_id resp_num cmd_byte ...
6033 Sends command @var{cmd_byte} and at most 20 following bytes and reads
6034 @var{resp_num} bytes afterwards. E.g. for 'Enter 4-byte address mode'
6035 @example
6036 jtagspi cmd 0 0 0xB7
6037 @end example
6038 @end deffn
6039
6040 @deffn Command {jtagspi always_4byte} bank_id [ on | off ]
6041 Some devices use 4-byte addresses for all commands except the legacy 0x03 read
6042 regardless of device size. This command controls the corresponding hack.
6043 @end deffn
6044 @end deffn
6045
6046 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xcf}
6047 @cindex Xilinx Platform flash driver
6048 @cindex xcf
6049 Xilinx FPGAs can be configured from specialized flash ICs named Platform Flash.
6050 It is (almost) regular NOR flash with erase sectors, program pages, etc. The
6051 only difference is special registers controlling its FPGA specific behavior.
6052 They must be properly configured for successful FPGA loading using
6053 additional @var{xcf} driver command:
6054
6055 @deffn {Command} {xcf ccb} <bank_id>
6056 command accepts additional parameters:
6057 @itemize
6058 @item @var{external|internal} ... selects clock source.
6059 @item @var{serial|parallel} ... selects serial or parallel data bus mode.
6060 @item @var{slave|master} ... selects slave of master mode for flash device.
6061 @item @var{40|20} ... selects clock frequency in MHz for internal clock
6062 in master mode.
6063 @end itemize
6064 @example
6065 xcf ccb 0 external parallel slave 40
6066 @end example
6067 All of them must be specified even if clock frequency is pointless
6068 in slave mode. If only bank id specified than command prints current
6069 CCB register value. Note: there is no need to write this register
6070 every time you erase/program data sectors because it stores in
6071 dedicated sector.
6072 @end deffn
6073
6074 @deffn {Command} {xcf configure} <bank_id>
6075 Initiates FPGA loading procedure. Useful if your board has no "configure"
6076 button.
6077 @example
6078 xcf configure 0
6079 @end example
6080 @end deffn
6081
6082 Additional driver notes:
6083 @itemize
6084 @item Only single revision supported.
6085 @item Driver automatically detects need of bit reverse, but
6086 only "bin" (raw binary, do not confuse it with "bit") and "mcs"
6087 (Intel hex) file types supported.
6088 @item For additional info check xapp972.pdf and ug380.pdf.
6089 @end itemize
6090 @end deffn
6091
6092 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpcspifi}
6093 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
6094 @cindex SPIFI
6095 @cindex lpcspifi
6096 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
6097 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
6098 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
6099
6100 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
6101 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
6102 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
6103 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
6104 significantly reduce flash programming times.
6105
6106 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
6107 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
6108 are configured by the driver.
6109
6110 @example
6111 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6112 @end example
6113
6114 @end deffn
6115
6116 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stmsmi}
6117 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
6118 @cindex SMI
6119 @cindex stmsmi
6120 Some devices from STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
6121 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
6122 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
6123 SPI flash devices.
6124 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
6125 flash devices can be connected.
6126
6127 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
6128 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
6129 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
6130 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
6131 the flash content.
6132
6133 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
6134 to identify the memory bank.
6135 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
6136 flash size, are detected automatically.
6137
6138 @example
6139 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6140 @end example
6141
6142 @end deffn
6143
6144 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stmqspi}
6145 @cindex STMicroelectronics QuadSPI/OctoSPI Interface
6146 @cindex QuadSPI
6147 @cindex OctoSPI
6148 @cindex stmqspi
6149 Some devices from STMicroelectronics include a proprietary ``QuadSPI Interface''
6150 (e.g. STM32F4, STM32F7, STM32L4) or ``OctoSPI Interface'' (e.g. STM32L4+)
6151 controller able to drive one or even two (dual mode) external SPI flash devices.
6152 The OctoSPI is a superset of QuadSPI, its presence is detected automatically.
6153 Currently only the regular command mode is supported, whereas the HyperFlash
6154 mode is not.
6155
6156 QuadSPI/OctoSPI makes the flash contents directly accessible in the CPU address
6157 space; in case of dual mode both devices must be of the same type and are
6158 mapped in the same memory bank (even and odd addresses interleaved).
6159 CPU can directly read data, execute code (but not boot) from QuadSPI bank.
6160
6161 The 'flash bank' command only requires the @var{base} parameter and the extra
6162 parameter @var{io_base} in order to identify the memory bank. Both are fixed
6163 by hardware, see datasheet or RM. All other parameters are ignored.
6164
6165 The controller must be initialized after each reset and properly configured
6166 for memory-mapped read operation for the particular flash chip(s), for the full
6167 list of available register settings cf. the controller's RM. This setup is quite
6168 board specific (that's why booting from this memory is not possible). The
6169 flash driver infers all parameters from current controller register values when
6170 'flash probe @var{bank_id}' is executed.
6171
6172 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display the flash content,
6173 but only after proper controller initialization as described above. However,
6174 due to a silicon bug in some devices, attempting to access the very last word
6175 should be avoided.
6176
6177 It is possible to use two (even different) flash chips alternatingly, if individual
6178 bank chip selects are available. For some package variants, this is not the case
6179 due to limited pin count. To switch from one to another, adjust FSEL bit accordingly
6180 and re-issue 'flash probe bank_id'. Note that the bank base address will @emph{not}
6181 change, so the address spaces of both devices will overlap. In dual flash mode
6182 both chips must be identical regarding size and most other properties.
6183
6184 Block or sector protection internal to the flash chip is not handled by this
6185 driver at all, but can be dealt with manually by the 'cmd' command, see below.
6186 The sector protection via 'flash protect' command etc. is completely internal to
6187 openocd, intended only to prevent accidental erase or overwrite and it does not
6188 persist across openocd invocations.
6189
6190 OpenOCD contains a hardcoded list of flash devices with their properties,
6191 these are auto-detected. If a device is not included in this list, SFDP discovery
6192 is attempted. If this fails or gives inappropriate results, manual setting is
6193 required (see 'set' command).
6194
6195 @example
6196 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x90000000 0 0 0 \
6197 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001000
6198 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x70000000 0 0 0 \
6199 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001400
6200 @end example
6201
6202 There are three specific commands
6203 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi mass_erase} bank_id
6204 Clears sector protections and performs a mass erase. Works only if there is no
6205 chip specific write protection engaged.
6206 @end deffn
6207
6208 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi set} bank_id name total_size page_size read_cmd fread_cmd pprg_cmd mass_erase_cmd sector_size sector_erase_cmd
6209 Set flash parameters: @var{name} human readable string, @var{total_size} size
6210 in bytes, @var{page_size} is write page size. @var{read_cmd}, @var{fread_cmd} and @var{pprg_cmd}
6211 are commands for reading and page programming. @var{fread_cmd} is used in DPI and QPI modes,
6212 @var{read_cmd} in normal SPI (single line) mode. @var{mass_erase_cmd}, @var{sector_size}
6213 and @var{sector_erase_cmd} are optional.
6214
6215 This command is required if chip id is not hardcoded yet and e.g. for EEPROMs or FRAMs
6216 which don't support an id command.
6217
6218 In dual mode parameters of both chips are set identically. The parameters refer to
6219 a single chip, so the whole bank gets twice the specified capacity etc.
6220 @end deffn
6221
6222 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi cmd} bank_id resp_num cmd_byte ...
6223 If @var{resp_num} is zero, sends command @var{cmd_byte} and following data
6224 bytes. In dual mode command byte is sent to @emph{both} chips but data bytes are
6225 sent @emph{alternatingly} to chip 1 and 2, first to flash 1, second to flash 2, etc.,
6226 i.e. the total number of bytes (including cmd_byte) must be odd.
6227
6228 If @var{resp_num} is not zero, cmd and at most four following data bytes are
6229 sent, in dual mode @emph{simultaneously} to both chips. Then @var{resp_num} bytes
6230 are read interleaved from both chips starting with chip 1. In this case
6231 @var{resp_num} must be even.
6232
6233 Note the hardware dictated subtle difference of those two cases in dual-flash mode.
6234
6235 To check basic communication settings, issue
6236 @example
6237 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
6238 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
6239 @end example
6240 for single flash mode or
6241 @example
6242 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
6243 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
6244 @end example
6245 for dual flash mode. This should return the status register contents.
6246
6247 In 8-line mode, @var{cmd_byte} is sent twice - first time as given, second time
6248 complemented. Additionally, in 8-line mode only, some commands (e.g. Read Status)
6249 need a dummy address, e.g.
6250 @example
6251 stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05 0x00 0x00 0x00 0x00
6252 @end example
6253 should return the status register contents.
6254
6255 @end deffn
6256
6257 @end deffn
6258
6259 @deffn {Flash Driver} {mrvlqspi}
6260 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
6261 Microcontroller platform.
6262
6263 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
6264 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
6265
6266 @example
6267 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
6268 @end example
6269
6270 @end deffn
6271
6272 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ath79}
6273 @cindex Atheros ath79 SPI driver
6274 @cindex ath79
6275 Members of ATH79 SoC family from Atheros include a SPI interface with 3
6276 chip selects.
6277 On reset a SPI flash connected to the first chip select (CS0) is made
6278 directly read-accessible in the CPU address space (up to 16MBytes)
6279 and is usually used to store the bootloader and operating system.
6280 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
6281 the flash content while it is in memory-mapped mode (only the first
6282 4MBytes are accessible without additional configuration on reset).
6283
6284 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
6285 to identify the memory bank. The actual value for the base address
6286 is not otherwise used by the driver. However the mapping is passed
6287 to gdb. Thus for the memory mapped flash (chipselect CS0) the base
6288 address should be the actual memory mapped base address. For unmapped
6289 chipselects (CS1 and CS2) care should be taken to use a base address
6290 that does not overlap with real memory regions.
6291 Additional information, like flash size, are detected automatically.
6292 An optional additional parameter sets the chipselect for the bank,
6293 with the default CS0.
6294 CS1 and CS2 require additional GPIO setup before they can be used
6295 since the alternate function must be enabled on the GPIO pin
6296 CS1/CS2 is routed to on the given SoC.
6297
6298 @example
6299 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6300
6301 # When using multiple chipselects the base should be different
6302 # for each, otherwise the write_image command is not able to
6303 # distinguish the banks.
6304 flash bank flash0 ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs0
6305 flash bank flash1 ath79 0x10000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs1
6306 flash bank flash2 ath79 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs2
6307 @end example
6308
6309 @end deffn
6310
6311 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fespi}
6312 @cindex Freedom E SPI
6313 @cindex fespi
6314
6315 SiFive's Freedom E SPI controller, used in HiFive and other boards.
6316
6317 @example
6318 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fespi 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6319 @end example
6320 @end deffn
6321
6322 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
6323
6324 @deffn {Flash Driver} {aduc702x}
6325 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
6326 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
6327 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
6328 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
6329 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
6330
6331 @example
6332 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6333 @end example
6334 @end deffn
6335
6336 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ambiqmicro}
6337 @cindex ambiqmicro
6338 @cindex apollo
6339 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
6340 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6341 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
6342 with the target using SWD.
6343
6344 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
6345 the device class of the MCU.
6346 The Flash and SRAM sizes directly follow device class, and are used
6347 to set up the flash banks.
6348 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
6349 sizes of an Apollo chip.
6350
6351 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
6352 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
6353 and the second bank starts after the first.
6354
6355 @example
6356 # Flash bank 0
6357 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6358 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
6359 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 \
6360 $_TARGETNAME
6361 @end example
6362
6363 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
6364 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
6365 are available to the user.
6366
6367 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
6368
6369 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
6370 Erase entire bank.
6371 @end deffn
6372 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
6373 Erase device pages.
6374 @end deffn
6375 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
6376 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
6377 The user writes sectors to SRAM starting at 0x10000010.
6378 Program OTP will write these sectors from SRAM to flash, and write protect
6379 the flash.
6380 @end deffn
6381 @end deffn
6382
6383 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91samd}
6384 @cindex at91samd
6385 All members of the ATSAM D2x, D1x, D0x, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
6386 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
6387
6388 Do not use for ATSAM D51 and E5x: use @xref{atsame5}.
6389
6390 The devices have one flash bank:
6391
6392 @example
6393 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91samd 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6394 @end example
6395
6396 @deffn {Command} {at91samd chip-erase}
6397 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
6398 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
6399 processor to be halted.
6400 @end deffn
6401
6402 @deffn {Command} {at91samd set-security}
6403 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
6404 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
6405 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
6406 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
6407 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
6408
6409 @example
6410 at91samd set-security enable
6411 @end example
6412 @end deffn
6413
6414 @deffn {Command} {at91samd eeprom}
6415 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
6416 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
6417 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
6418 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
6419 requires additional firmware support and the minimum EEPROM size may not be
6420 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
6421 in order to disable this feature.
6422
6423 @example
6424 at91samd eeprom
6425 at91samd eeprom 1024
6426 @end example
6427 @end deffn
6428
6429 @deffn {Command} {at91samd bootloader}
6430 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
6431 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
6432 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
6433 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
6434 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
6435
6436 @example
6437 at91samd bootloader
6438 at91samd bootloader 16384
6439 @end example
6440 @end deffn
6441
6442 @deffn {Command} {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
6443 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
6444 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6445 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6446 @end deffn
6447
6448 @deffn {Command} {at91samd nvmuserrow}
6449 Writes or reads the entire 64 bit wide NVM user row register which is located at
6450 0x804000. This register includes various fuses lock-bits and factory calibration
6451 data. Reading the register is done by invoking this command without any
6452 arguments. Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
6453 is the register value to be written and the second one is an optional changemask.
6454 Every bit which value in changemask is 0 will stay unchanged. The lock- and
6455 reserved-bits are masked out and cannot be changed.
6456
6457 @example
6458 # Read user row
6459 >at91samd nvmuserrow
6460 NVMUSERROW: 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
6461 # Write 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788 to user row
6462 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
6463 # Write 0x12300 to user row but leave other bits and low
6464 # byte unchanged
6465 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0x12345 0xFFF00
6466 @end example
6467 @end deffn
6468
6469 @end deffn
6470
6471 @anchor{at91sam3}
6472 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam3}
6473 @cindex at91sam3
6474 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
6475 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
6476 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
6477 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
6478 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
6479 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
6480 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrisome comment after other
6481 chips are confirmed.}
6482
6483 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
6484 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
6485 the following fixed locations:
6486
6487 @example
6488 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
6489 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6490 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
6491 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6492 @end example
6493
6494 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
6495 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
6496 to the @command{flash bank} command:
6497
6498 @itemize
6499 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
6500 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
6501 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
6502 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
6503 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
6504 @end itemize
6505
6506 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
6507
6508 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm}
6509 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
6510 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
6511 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
6512 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
6513 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
6514 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
6515
6516 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
6517 modifies that GPNVM bit.
6518 @end deffn
6519
6520 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 info}
6521 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
6522 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
6523 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
6524 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
6525 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
6526 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
6527 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
6528 @end deffn
6529
6530 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
6531 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
6532 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
6533 @end deffn
6534 @end deffn
6535
6536 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam4}
6537 @cindex at91sam4
6538 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
6539 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6540 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6541 @end deffn
6542
6543 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam4l}
6544 @cindex at91sam4l
6545 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
6546 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6547 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6548
6549 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
6550 @deffn {Command} {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
6551 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
6552 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6553 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6554 @end deffn
6555 @end deffn
6556
6557 @anchor{atsame5}
6558 @deffn {Flash Driver} {atsame5}
6559 @cindex atsame5
6560 All members of the SAM E54, E53, E51 and D51 microcontroller
6561 families from Microchip (former Atmel) include internal flash
6562 and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6563
6564 The devices have two ECC flash banks with a swapping feature.
6565 This driver handles both banks together as it were one.
6566 Bank swapping is not supported yet.
6567
6568 @example
6569 flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsame5 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6570 @end example
6571
6572 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 bootloader}
6573 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Page of the
6574 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
6575 must be specified in bytes. The nearest bigger protection size is used.
6576 Settings are written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset.
6577 Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
6578
6579 @example
6580 atsame5 bootloader
6581 atsame5 bootloader 16384
6582 @end example
6583 @end deffn
6584
6585 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 chip-erase}
6586 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
6587 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
6588 processor to be halted.
6589 @end deffn
6590
6591 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 dsu_reset_deassert}
6592 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
6593 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6594 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6595 @end deffn
6596
6597 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 userpage}
6598 Writes or reads the first 64 bits of NVM User Page which is located at
6599 0x804000. This field includes various fuses.
6600 Reading is done by invoking this command without any arguments.
6601 Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
6602 is the value to be written and the second one is an optional bit mask
6603 (a zero bit in the mask means the bit stays unchanged).
6604 The reserved fields are always masked out and cannot be changed.
6605
6606 @example
6607 # Read
6608 >atsame5 userpage
6609 USER PAGE: 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6610 # Write
6611 >atsame5 userpage 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6612 # Write 2 to SEESBLK and 4 to SEEPSZ fields but leave other
6613 # bits unchanged (setup SmartEEPROM of virtual size 8192
6614 # bytes)
6615 >atsame5 userpage 0x4200000000 0x7f00000000
6616 @end example
6617 @end deffn
6618
6619 @end deffn
6620
6621 @deffn {Flash Driver} {atsamv}
6622 @cindex atsamv
6623 All members of the ATSAMV7x, ATSAMS70, and ATSAME70 families from
6624 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
6625 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6626
6627 @example
6628 flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsamv 0x00400000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6629 @end example
6630
6631 @deffn {Command} {atsamv gpnvm} [@option{show} [@option{all}|number]]
6632 @deffnx {Command} {atsamv gpnvm} (@option{clr}|@option{set}) number
6633 With no parameters, @option{show} or @option{show all},
6634 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
6635 With @option{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
6636
6637 With @option{set} @var{number} or @option{clear} @var{number},
6638 modifies that GPNVM bit.
6639 @end deffn
6640
6641 @end deffn
6642
6643 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam7}
6644 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
6645 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
6646 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
6647 register, and autoconfigures itself.
6648
6649 @example
6650 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6651 @end example
6652
6653 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
6654 provide additional parameters in the following order:
6655
6656 @itemize
6657 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
6658 @item @var{banks}
6659 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
6660 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
6661 @item @var{pages_size}
6662 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
6663 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
6664 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
6665 @end itemize
6666
6667 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
6668 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
6669 will be autoconfigured.
6670 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
6671
6672 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
6673 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
6674 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
6675 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
6676 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
6677
6678 @deffn {Command} {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
6679 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
6680 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
6681 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
6682 are not truly general purpose).
6683 @quotation Note
6684 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
6685 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
6686 @end quotation
6687 @end deffn
6688 @end deffn
6689
6690 @deffn {Flash Driver} {avr}
6691 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
6692 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
6693 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6694 @end deffn
6695
6696 @deffn {Flash Driver} {bluenrg-x}
6697 STMicroelectronics BlueNRG-1, BlueNRG-2 and BlueNRG-LP/LPS Bluetooth low energy wireless system-on-chip. They include ARM Cortex-M0/M0+ core and internal flash memory.
6698 The driver automatically recognizes these chips using
6699 the chip identification registers, and autoconfigures itself.
6700
6701 @example
6702 flash bank $_FLASHNAME bluenrg-x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6703 @end example
6704
6705 Note that when users ask to erase all the sectors of the flash, a mass erase command is used which is faster than erasing
6706 each single sector one by one.
6707
6708 @example
6709 flash erase_sector 0 0 last # It will perform a mass erase
6710 @end example
6711
6712 Triggering a mass erase is also useful when users want to disable readout protection.
6713 @end deffn
6714
6715 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cc26xx}
6716 All versions of the SimpleLink CC13xx and CC26xx microcontrollers from Texas
6717 Instruments include internal flash. The cc26xx flash driver supports both the
6718 CC13xx and CC26xx family of devices. The driver automatically recognizes the
6719 specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself. The flash bank
6720 starts at address 0.
6721
6722 @example
6723 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc26xx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6724 @end example
6725 @end deffn
6726
6727 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cc3220sf}
6728 The CC3220SF version of the SimpleLink CC32xx microcontrollers from Texas
6729 Instruments includes 1MB of internal flash. The cc3220sf flash driver only
6730 supports the internal flash. The serial flash on SimpleLink boards is
6731 programmed via the bootloader over a UART connection. Security features of
6732 the CC3220SF may erase the internal flash during power on reset. Refer to
6733 documentation at @url{www.ti.com/cc3220sf} for details on security features
6734 and programming the serial flash.
6735
6736 @example
6737 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc3220sf 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6738 @end example
6739 @end deffn
6740
6741 @deffn {Flash Driver} {efm32}
6742 All members of the EFM32/EFR32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro (now Silicon Labs)
6743 include internal flash and use Arm Cortex-M3 or Cortex-M4 cores. The driver automatically
6744 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
6745 autoconfigures itself.
6746 @example
6747 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6748 @end example
6749 It supports writing to the user data page, as well as the portion of the lockbits page
6750 past 512 bytes on chips with larger page sizes. The latter is used by the SiLabs
6751 bootloader/AppLoader system for encryption keys. Setting protection on these pages is
6752 currently not supported.
6753 @example
6754 flash bank userdata.flash efm32 0x0FE00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6755 flash bank lockbits.flash efm32 0x0FE04000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6756 @end example
6757
6758 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
6759 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
6760 this via the following command:
6761 @example
6762 efm32 debuglock num
6763 @end example
6764 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6765 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
6766 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
6767 supported.}
6768 @end deffn
6769
6770 @deffn {Flash Driver} {esirisc}
6771 Members of the eSi-RISC family may optionally include internal flash programmed
6772 via the eSi-TSMC Flash interface. Additional parameters are required to
6773 configure the driver: @option{cfg_address} is the base address of the
6774 configuration register interface, @option{clock_hz} is the expected clock
6775 frequency, and @option{wait_states} is the number of configured read wait states.
6776
6777 @example
6778 flash bank $_FLASHNAME esirisc base_address size_bytes 0 0 \
6779 $_TARGETNAME cfg_address clock_hz wait_states
6780 @end example
6781
6782 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flash mass_erase} bank_id
6783 Erase all pages in data memory for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}.
6784 @end deffn
6785
6786 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flash ref_erase} bank_id
6787 Erase the reference cell for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}. @emph{This
6788 is an uncommon operation.}
6789 @end deffn
6790 @end deffn
6791
6792 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fm3}
6793 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
6794 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6795 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
6796 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6797 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
6798 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
6799
6800 @example
6801 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6802 @end example
6803 @end deffn
6804
6805 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fm4}
6806 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
6807 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
6808 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
6809 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6810 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
6811 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
6812 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
6813 characters) ignored.
6814
6815 @example
6816 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 \
6817 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6818 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 \
6819 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6820 @end example
6821 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
6822 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
6823 @end deffn
6824
6825 @deffn {Flash Driver} {kinetis}
6826 @cindex kinetis
6827 Kx, KLx, KVx and KE1x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family
6828 from NXP (former Freescale) include
6829 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
6830 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
6831 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6832 Use kinetis_ke driver for KE0x and KEAx devices.
6833
6834 The @var{kinetis} driver defines option:
6835 @itemize
6836 @item -sim-base @var{addr} ... base of System Integration Module where chip identification resides. Driver tries two known locations if option is omitted.
6837 @end itemize
6838
6839 @example
6840 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6841 @end example
6842
6843 @deffn {Config Command} {kinetis create_banks}
6844 Configuration command enables automatic creation of additional flash banks
6845 based on real flash layout of device. Banks are created during device probe.
6846 Use 'flash probe 0' to force probe.
6847 @end deffn
6848
6849 @deffn {Command} {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
6850 Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
6851 @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
6852 set by 'flash protect' command.
6853 This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
6854 writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
6855 @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
6856 Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
6857 with the rest of a flash image.
6858 @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
6859 @end deffn
6860
6861 @deffn {Command} {kinetis fopt} [num]
6862 Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
6863 Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
6864 @end deffn
6865
6866 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm check_security}
6867 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end
6868 and examine-fail event.
6869 @end deffn
6870
6871 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm halt}
6872 Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
6873 loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
6874 @end deffn
6875
6876 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
6877 Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
6878 back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
6879 to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
6880 command completes.
6881 @end deffn
6882
6883 @deffn {Command} {kinetis nvm_partition}
6884 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
6885 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
6886 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
6887 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
6888
6889 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
6890 Program Partition command.
6891
6892 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
6893 Reset the device after partition setting.
6894
6895 Show partition size:
6896 @example
6897 kinetis nvm_partition info
6898 @end example
6899
6900 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
6901 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6902 @example
6903 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
6904 @end example
6905
6906 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
6907 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6908 @example
6909 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
6910 @end example
6911 @end deffn
6912
6913 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm reset}
6914 Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
6915 RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
6916 @end deffn
6917
6918 @deffn {Command} {kinetis disable_wdog}
6919 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
6920 Command disables watchdog timer.
6921 @end deffn
6922 @end deffn
6923
6924 @deffn {Flash Driver} {kinetis_ke}
6925 @cindex kinetis_ke
6926 KE0x and KEAx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from NXP include
6927 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
6928 the KE0x sub-family using the chip identification register, and
6929 autoconfigures itself.
6930 Use kinetis (not kinetis_ke) driver for KE1x devices.
6931
6932 @example
6933 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6934 @end example
6935
6936 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
6937 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
6938 @end deffn
6939
6940 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
6941 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
6942 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
6943 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
6944 It does not require the processor to be halted.
6945 @end deffn
6946
6947 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
6948 Command disables watchdog timer.
6949 @end deffn
6950 @end deffn
6951
6952 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc2000}
6953 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
6954 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
6955 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000, LPC54100,
6956 LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx microcontroller families from NXP.
6957
6958 @quotation Note
6959 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
6960 driver:
6961 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
6962 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
6963 @end quotation
6964
6965 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and two optional parameters,
6966 which must appear in the following order:
6967
6968 @itemize
6969 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
6970 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
6971 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
6972 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
6973 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
6974 LPC43x[2357])
6975 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
6976 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
6977 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
6978 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
6979 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
6980 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
6981 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx, LPC40xx, LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx
6982 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
6983 at which the core is running
6984 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
6985 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
6986 @quotation Note
6987 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
6988 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
6989 However, if you do provide it,
6990 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
6991 @end quotation
6992 @item @option{iap_entry} ... optional telling the driver to use a different
6993 ROM IAP entry point.
6994 @end itemize
6995
6996 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6997
6998 @example
6999 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
7000 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
7001 @end example
7002
7003 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
7004 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
7005 the specified flash @var{bank}.
7006 @end deffn
7007 @end deffn
7008
7009 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc288x}
7010 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
7011 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
7012 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
7013 the programming clock rate in Hz.
7014 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7015
7016 @example
7017 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
7018 @end example
7019 @end deffn
7020
7021 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc2900}
7022 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
7023 from NXP.
7024
7025 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
7026 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
7027 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
7028 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
7029 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
7030 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
7031 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
7032 you start the PLL.
7033
7034 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
7035
7036 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
7037 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
7038 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
7039
7040 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
7041 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
7042 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
7043 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
7044 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
7045 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
7046 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
7047
7048 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
7049 @example
7050 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
7051 @end example
7052
7053 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
7054 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
7055 @code{flash banks} command.
7056
7057 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 signature} bank
7058 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
7059 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
7060 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
7061 a known signature.
7062 Example:
7063 @example
7064 lpc2900 signature 0
7065 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
7066 @end example
7067 @end deffn
7068
7069 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
7070 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
7071 saves it to a file in binary format.
7072 Example:
7073 @example
7074 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
7075 @end example
7076 @end deffn
7077
7078 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
7079 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
7080 commands need to be preceded by a successful call to the @code{password}
7081 command:
7082
7083 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 password} bank password
7084 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
7085 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
7086 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
7087
7088 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
7089 Example:
7090 @example
7091 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
7092 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
7093 @end example
7094 @end deffn
7095
7096 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
7097 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
7098 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
7099 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
7100 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
7101 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
7102 912 bytes.
7103 @quotation Attention
7104 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
7105 @end quotation
7106 Example:
7107 @example
7108 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
7109 @end example
7110 @end deffn
7111
7112 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
7113 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
7114 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
7115 after the next power cycle.
7116 @quotation Attention
7117 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
7118 @end quotation
7119 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
7120 Example:
7121 @example
7122 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
7123 flash info 0
7124 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
7125 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
7126 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
7127 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
7128 @end example
7129 @end deffn
7130
7131 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
7132 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
7133 effective after the next power cycle.
7134 @quotation Attention
7135 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
7136 @end quotation
7137 Examples:
7138 @example
7139 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
7140 @end example
7141 @end deffn
7142 @end deffn
7143
7144 @deffn {Flash Driver} {mdr}
7145 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
7146 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
7147 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
7148
7149 @example
7150 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
7151 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
7152 @end example
7153
7154 @itemize @bullet
7155 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
7156 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
7157 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
7158 @end itemize
7159
7160 Example usage:
7161 @example
7162 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
7163 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
7164 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
7165 @} else @{
7166 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
7167 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
7168 @}
7169 @end example
7170 @end deffn
7171
7172 @deffn {Flash Driver} {msp432}
7173 All versions of the SimpleLink MSP432 microcontrollers from Texas
7174 Instruments include internal flash. The msp432 flash driver automatically
7175 recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself.
7176 Main program flash starts at address 0. The information flash region on
7177 MSP432P4 versions starts at address 0x200000.
7178
7179 @example
7180 flash bank $_FLASHNAME msp432 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7181 @end example
7182
7183 @deffn {Command} {msp432 mass_erase} bank_id [main|all]
7184 Performs a complete erase of flash. By default, @command{mass_erase} will erase
7185 only the main program flash.
7186
7187 On MSP432P4 versions, using @command{mass_erase all} will erase both the
7188 main program and information flash regions. To also erase the BSL in information
7189 flash, the user must first use the @command{bsl} command.
7190 @end deffn
7191
7192 @deffn {Command} {msp432 bsl} bank_id [unlock|lock]
7193 On MSP432P4 versions, @command{bsl} unlocks and locks the bootstrap loader (BSL)
7194 region in information flash so that flash commands can erase or write the BSL.
7195 Leave the BSL locked to prevent accidentally corrupting the bootstrap loader.
7196
7197 To erase and program the BSL:
7198 @example
7199 msp432 bsl unlock
7200 flash erase_address 0x202000 0x2000
7201 flash write_image bsl.bin 0x202000
7202 msp432 bsl lock
7203 @end example
7204 @end deffn
7205 @end deffn
7206
7207 @deffn {Flash Driver} {niietcm4}
7208 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
7209 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
7210 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
7211 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
7212 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
7213 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
7214 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
7215 also have division into regions: main and info.
7216 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
7217 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memory.
7218
7219 @example
7220 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7221 @end example
7222
7223 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
7224
7225 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
7226 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
7227 @end deffn
7228
7229 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
7230 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
7231 @end deffn
7232
7233 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
7234 Erase all userflash including info region.
7235 @end deffn
7236
7237 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
7238 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
7239 @end deffn
7240
7241 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
7242 Check sectors protect.
7243 @end deffn
7244
7245 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
7246 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
7247 @end deffn
7248
7249 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
7250 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
7251 @end deffn
7252
7253 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
7254 Configure external memory interface for boot.
7255 @end deffn
7256
7257 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
7258 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
7259 @end deffn
7260
7261 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
7262 Show information about flash driver.
7263 @end deffn
7264
7265 @end deffn
7266
7267 @deffn {Flash Driver} {npcx}
7268 All versions of the NPCX microcontroller families from Nuvoton include internal
7269 flash. The NPCX flash driver supports the NPCX family of devices. The driver
7270 automatically recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and
7271 autoconfigures itself. The flash bank starts at address 0x64000000. An optional additional
7272 parameter sets the FIU version for the bank, with the default FIU is @var{npcx.fiu}.
7273
7274 @example
7275
7276 flash bank $_FLASHNAME npcx 0x64000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME npcx_v2.fiu
7277
7278 # FIU defaults to npcx.fiu
7279 flash bank $_FLASHNAME npcx 0x64000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7280
7281 @end example
7282 @end deffn
7283
7284 @deffn {Flash Driver} {nrf5}
7285 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
7286 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core. nRF52 family powered
7287 by ARM Cortex-M4 or M4F core is supported too. nRF52832 is fully supported
7288 including BPROT flash protection scheme. nRF52833 and nRF52840 devices are
7289 supported with the exception of security extensions (flash access control list
7290 - ACL).
7291
7292 @example
7293 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf5 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7294 @end example
7295
7296 Some nrf5-specific commands are defined:
7297
7298 @deffn {Command} {nrf5 mass_erase}
7299 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
7300 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
7301 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
7302 code.
7303 @end deffn
7304
7305 @deffn {Command} {nrf5 info}
7306 Decodes and shows information from FICR and UICR registers.
7307 @end deffn
7308
7309 @end deffn
7310
7311 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ocl}
7312 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
7313 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
7314
7315 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
7316 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
7317 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
7318 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
7319
7320 @example
7321 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7322 @end example
7323 @end deffn
7324
7325 @deffn {Flash Driver} {pic32mx}
7326 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
7327 and integrate flash memory.
7328
7329 @example
7330 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7331 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7332 @end example
7333
7334 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
7335 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
7336 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
7337 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
7338 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
7339 @deffn {Command} {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
7340 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
7341 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
7342 @end deffn
7343 @deffn {Command} {pic32mx unlock} bank
7344 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
7345 This will remove any Code Protection.
7346 @end deffn
7347 @end deffn
7348
7349 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc4}
7350 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
7351 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
7352 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7353 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7354
7355 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
7356 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
7357
7358 @example
7359 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7360 @end example
7361
7362 psoc4-specific commands
7363 @deffn {Command} {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
7364 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
7365
7366 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
7367 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
7368
7369 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
7370 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
7371 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
7372
7373 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7374 @end deffn
7375
7376 @deffn {Command} {psoc4 mass_erase} num
7377 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
7378
7379 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7380 @end deffn
7381 @end deffn
7382
7383 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp}
7384 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
7385 include internal program flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
7386 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
7387 apart from the base address.
7388
7389 @example
7390 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc5lp 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7391 @end example
7392
7393 @b{Note:} PSoC 5LP chips can be configured to have ECC enabled or disabled.
7394 @quotation Attention
7395 If flash operations are performed in ECC-disabled mode, they will also affect
7396 the ECC flash region. Erasing a 16k flash sector in the 0x00000000 area will
7397 then also erase the corresponding 2k data bytes in the 0x48000000 area.
7398 Writing to the ECC data bytes in ECC-disabled mode is not implemented.
7399 @end quotation
7400
7401 Commands defined in the @var{psoc5lp} driver:
7402
7403 @deffn {Command} {psoc5lp mass_erase}
7404 Erases all flash data and ECC/configuration bytes, all flash protection rows,
7405 and all row latches in all flash arrays on the device.
7406 @end deffn
7407 @end deffn
7408
7409 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp_eeprom}
7410 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
7411 include internal EEPROM and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
7412 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
7413 apart from the base address.
7414
7415 @example
7416 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.eeprom psoc5lp_eeprom 0x40008000 0 0 0 \
7417 $_TARGETNAME
7418 @end example
7419 @end deffn
7420
7421 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp_nvl}
7422 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
7423 include internal Nonvolatile Latches and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
7424 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself.
7425
7426 @example
7427 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.nvl psoc5lp_nvl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7428 @end example
7429
7430 PSoC 5LP chips have multiple NV Latches:
7431
7432 @itemize
7433 @item Device Configuration NV Latch - 4 bytes
7434 @item Write Once (WO) NV Latch - 4 bytes
7435 @end itemize
7436
7437 @b{Note:} This driver only implements the Device Configuration NVL.
7438
7439 The @var{psoc5lp} driver reads the ECC mode from Device Configuration NVL.
7440 @quotation Attention
7441 Switching ECC mode via write to Device Configuration NVL will require a reset
7442 after successful write.
7443 @end quotation
7444 @end deffn
7445
7446 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc6}
7447 Supports PSoC6 (CY8C6xxx) family of Cypress microcontrollers.
7448 PSoC6 is a dual-core device with CM0+ and CM4 cores. Both cores share
7449 the same Flash/RAM/MMIO address space.
7450
7451 Flash in PSoC6 is split into three regions:
7452 @itemize @bullet
7453 @item Main Flash - this is the main storage for user application.
7454 Total size varies among devices, sector size: 256 kBytes, row size:
7455 512 bytes. Supports erase operation on individual rows.
7456 @item Work Flash - intended to be used as storage for user data
7457 (e.g. EEPROM emulation). Total size: 32 KBytes, sector size: 32 KBytes,
7458 row size: 512 bytes.
7459 @item Supervisory Flash - special region which contains device-specific
7460 service data. This region does not support erase operation. Only few rows can
7461 be programmed by the user, most of the rows are read only. Programming
7462 operation will erase row automatically.
7463 @end itemize
7464
7465 All three flash regions are supported by the driver. Flash geometry is detected
7466 automatically by parsing data in SPCIF_GEOMETRY register.
7467
7468 PSoC6 is equipped with NOR Flash so erased Flash reads as 0x00.
7469
7470 @example
7471 flash bank main_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
7472 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7473 flash bank work_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
7474 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7475 flash bank super_flash_user_cm0 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
7476 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7477 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm0 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
7478 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7479 flash bank super_flash_key_cm0 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
7480 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7481 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm0 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
7482 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7483
7484 flash bank main_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
7485 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7486 flash bank work_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
7487 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7488 flash bank super_flash_user_cm4 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
7489 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7490 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm4 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
7491 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7492 flash bank super_flash_key_cm4 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
7493 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7494 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm4 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
7495 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7496 @end example
7497
7498 psoc6-specific commands
7499 @deffn {Command} {psoc6 reset_halt}
7500 Command can be used to simulate broken Vector Catch from gdbinit or tcl scripts.
7501 When invoked for CM0+ target, it will set break point at application entry point
7502 and issue SYSRESETREQ. This will reset both cores and all peripherals. CM0+ will
7503 reset CM4 during boot anyway so this is safe. On CM4 target, VECTRESET is used
7504 instead of SYSRESETREQ to avoid unwanted reset of CM0+;
7505 @end deffn
7506
7507 @deffn {Command} {psoc6 mass_erase} num
7508 Erases the contents given flash bank. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown
7509 by @command{flash banks}.
7510 Note: only Main and Work flash regions support Erase operation.
7511 @end deffn
7512 @end deffn
7513
7514 @deffn {Flash Driver} {qn908x}
7515 The NXP QN908x microcontrollers feature a Cortex-M4F with integrated Bluetooth
7516 LE 5 support and an internal flash of up to 512 KiB. These chips only support
7517 the SWD interface.
7518
7519 The @var{qn908x} driver uses the internal "Flash Memory Controller" block via
7520 SWD to erase, program and read the internal flash. This driver does not
7521 support the ISP (In-System Programming) mode which is an alternate way to
7522 program the flash via UART, SPI or USB.
7523
7524 The internal flash is 512 KiB in size in all released chips and it starts at
7525 the address 0x01000000, although it can be mapped to address 0 and it is
7526 aliased to other addresses. This driver only recognizes the bank starting at
7527 address 0x01000000.
7528
7529 The internal bootloader stored in ROM is in charge of loading and verifying
7530 the image from flash, or enter ISP mode. The programmed image must start at
7531 the beginning of the flash and contain a valid header and a matching CRC32
7532 checksum. Additionally, the image header contains a "Code Read Protection"
7533 (CRP) word which indicates whether SWD access is enabled, as well as whether
7534 ISP mode is enabled. Therefore, it is possible to program an image that
7535 disables SWD and ISP making it impossible to program another image in the
7536 future through these interfaces, or even debug the current image. While this is
7537 a valid use case for production deployments where the chips are locked down, by
7538 default this driver doesn't allow such images that disable the SWD interface.
7539 To program such images see the @command{qn908x allow_brick} command.
7540
7541 Apart from the CRP field which is located in the image header, the last page
7542 of the flash memory contains a "Flash lock and protect" descriptor which allows
7543 to individually protect each 2 KiB page, as well as disabling SWD access to the
7544 flash and RAM. If this access is disabled it is not possible to read, erase or
7545 program individual pages from the SWD interface or even access the read-only
7546 "Flash information page" with information about the bootloader version and
7547 flash size. However when this protection is in place, it is still possible to
7548 mass erase the whole chip and then program a new image, for which you can use
7549 the @command{qn908x mass_erase}.
7550
7551 Example:
7552 @example
7553 flash bank $FLASHNAME qn908x 0x01000000 0 0 0 $TARGETNAME calc_checksum
7554 @end example
7555
7556 Parameters:
7557 @itemize
7558 @item @option{calc_checksum} optional parameter to compute the required
7559 checksum of the first bytes in the vector table.
7560 @quotation Note
7561 If the checksum in the header of your image is invalid and you don't provide the
7562 @option{calc_checksum} option the boot ROM will not boot your image and it may
7563 render the flash inaccessible. On the other hand, if you use this option to
7564 compute the checksum keep in mind that @command{verify_image} will fail on
7565 those four bytes of the checksum since those bytes in the flash will have the
7566 updated checksum.
7567 @end quotation
7568 @end itemize
7569
7570 @deffn {Command} {qn908x allow_brick}
7571 Allow the qn908x driver to program images with a "Code Read Protection" byte
7572 that disables the SWD access. Programming such image will cause OpenOCD to
7573 not be able to reach the target over SWD anymore after the new image is
7574 programmed and its configuration takes effect, e.g. after a reboot. After
7575 executing @command{qn908x allow_brick} these images will be allowed to be
7576 programmed when writing to the flash.
7577 @end deffn
7578
7579 @deffn {Command} {qn908x disable_wdog}
7580 Disable the watchdog timer (WDT) by resetting its CTRL field. The WDT starts
7581 enabled after a @command{reset halt} and it doesn't run while the target is
7582 halted. However, the verification process in this driver uses the generic
7583 Cortex-M verification process which executes a payload in RAM and thus
7584 requires the watchdog to be disabled before running @command{verify_image}
7585 after a reset halt or any other condition where the watchdog is running.
7586 Note that this is not done automatically and you must run this command in
7587 those scenarios.
7588 @end deffn
7589
7590 @deffn {Command} {qn908x mass_erase}
7591 Erases the complete flash using the mass_erase method. Mass erase is only
7592 allowed if enabled in the Lock Status Register 8 (LOCK_STAT_8) which is read
7593 from the last sector of the flash on boot. However, this mass_erase lock
7594 protection can be bypassed and this command does so automatically.
7595
7596 In the same LOCK_STAT_8 the flash and RAM access from SWD can be disabled by
7597 setting two bits in this register. After a mass_erase, all the bits of the
7598 flash would be set, making it the default to restrict SWD access to the flash
7599 and RAM regions. This new after erase LOCK_STAT_8 value only takes effect after
7600 being read from flash on the next reboot for example. After a mass_erase the
7601 LOCK_STAT_8 register is changed by the hardware to allow access to flash and
7602 RAM regardless of the value on flash, but only right after a mass_erase and
7603 until the next boot. Therefore it is possible to perform a mass_erase, program
7604 a new image, verify it and then reboot to a valid image that's locked from the
7605 SWD access.
7606
7607 The @command{qn908x mass_erase} command clears the bits that would be loaded
7608 from the flash into LOCK_STAT_8 after erasing the whole chip to allow SWD
7609 access for debugging or re-flashing an image without a mass_erase by default.
7610 If the image being programmed also programs the last page of the flash with its
7611 own settings, this mass_erase behavior will interfere with that write since a
7612 new erase of at least the last page would need to be performed before writing
7613 to it again. For this reason the optional @option{keep_lock} argument can be
7614 used to leave the flash and RAM lock set. For development environments, the
7615 default behavior is desired.
7616
7617 The mass erase locking mechanism is independent from the individual page
7618 locking bits, so it is possible that you can't erase a given page that is
7619 locked and you can't unprotect that page because the locking bits are also
7620 locked, but can still mass erase the whole flash.
7621 @end deffn
7622 @end deffn
7623
7624 @deffn {Flash Driver} {rp2040}
7625 Supports RP2040 "Raspberry Pi Pico" microcontroller.
7626 RP2040 is a dual-core device with two CM0+ cores. Both cores share the same
7627 Flash/RAM/MMIO address space. Non-volatile storage is achieved with an
7628 external QSPI flash; a Boot ROM provides helper functions.
7629
7630 @example
7631 flash bank $_FLASHNAME rp2040_flash $_FLASHBASE $_FLASHSIZE 1 32 $_TARGETNAME
7632 @end example
7633 @end deffn
7634
7635 @deffn {Flash Driver} {rsl10}
7636 Supports Onsemi RSL10 microcontroller flash memory. Uses functions
7637 stored in ROM to control flash memory interface.
7638
7639 @example
7640 flash bank $_FLASHNAME rsl10 $_FLASHBASE $_FLASHSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7641 @end example
7642
7643 @deffn {Command} {rsl10 lock} key1 key2 key3 key4
7644 Writes @var{key1 key2 key3 key4} words to @var{0x81044 0x81048 0x8104c
7645 0x8050}. Locks debug port by writing @var{0x4C6F634B} to @var{0x81040}.
7646
7647 To unlock use the @command{rsl10 unlock key1 key2 key3 key4} command.
7648 @end deffn
7649
7650 @deffn {Command} {rsl10 unlock} key1 key2 key3 key4
7651 Unlocks debug port, by writing @var{key1 key2 key3 key4} words to
7652 registers through DAP, and clears @var{0x81040} address in flash to 0x1.
7653 @end deffn
7654
7655 @deffn {Command} {rsl10 mass_erase}
7656 Erases all unprotected flash sectors.
7657 @end deffn
7658 @end deffn
7659
7660 @deffn {Flash Driver} {sim3x}
7661 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
7662 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
7663 and SWD interface.
7664 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
7665 If this fails, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
7666
7667 @example
7668 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7669 @end example
7670
7671 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
7672
7673 @deffn {Command} {sim3x mass_erase}
7674 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
7675 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
7676 @end deffn
7677
7678 @deffn {Command} {sim3x lock}
7679 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
7680 @end deffn
7681 @end deffn
7682
7683 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stellaris}
7684 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
7685 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
7686 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
7687 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7688
7689 @example
7690 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7691 @end example
7692
7693 @deffn {Command} {stellaris recover}
7694 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
7695 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
7696 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
7697 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
7698 disabled.
7699
7700 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
7701 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
7702 @quotation Warning
7703 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
7704 applied to all of them.
7705 @end quotation
7706 @end deffn
7707 @end deffn
7708
7709 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32f1x}
7710 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
7711 from STMicroelectronics and all members of the GD32F1x0, GD32F3x0 and GD32E23x microcontroller
7712 families from GigaDevice include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4/M23 cores.
7713 The driver also works with GD32VF103 powered by RISC-V core.
7714 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7715 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7716
7717 @example
7718 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7719 @end example
7720
7721 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7722 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7723 the flash driver.
7724
7725 @example
7726 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7727 @end example
7728
7729 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
7730 as per the following example.
7731 @example
7732 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7733 @end example
7734
7735 Some stm32f1x-specific commands are defined:
7736
7737 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x lock} num
7738 Locks the entire stm32 device against reading.
7739 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7740 @end deffn
7741
7742 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x unlock} num
7743 Unlocks the entire stm32 device for reading. This command will cause
7744 a mass erase of the entire stm32 device if previously locked.
7745 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7746 @end deffn
7747
7748 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x mass_erase} num
7749 Mass erases the entire stm32 device.
7750 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7751 @end deffn
7752
7753 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_read} num
7754 Reads and displays active stm32 option bytes loaded during POR
7755 or upon executing the @command{stm32f1x options_load} command.
7756 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7757 @end deffn
7758
7759 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP}) (@option{USEROPT} user_data)
7760 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
7761 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7762 The @var{user_data} parameter is content of higher 16 bits of the option byte register (Data0 and Data1 as one 16bit number).
7763 @end deffn
7764
7765 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_load} num
7766 Generates a special kind of reset to re-load the stm32 option bytes written
7767 by the @command{stm32f1x options_write} or @command{flash protect} commands
7768 without having to power cycle the target. Not applicable to stm32f1x devices.
7769 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7770 @end deffn
7771 @end deffn
7772
7773 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32f2x}
7774 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7775 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
7776 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7777 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7778
7779 @example
7780 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7781 @end example
7782
7783 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
7784 as per the following example.
7785 @example
7786 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0x1FFF7800 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7787 @end example
7788
7789 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x otp} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7790 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7791 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7792 @end deffn
7793
7794 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7795 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7796 the flash driver.
7797
7798 @example
7799 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7800 @end example
7801
7802 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
7803
7804 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x lock} num
7805 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7806 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7807 @end deffn
7808
7809 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x unlock} num
7810 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7811 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7812 @end deffn
7813
7814 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x mass_erase} num
7815 Mass erases the entire stm32f2x device.
7816 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7817 @end deffn
7818
7819 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x options_read} num
7820 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0, boot_addr1, optcr2.
7821 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7822 @end deffn
7823
7824 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
7825 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
7826 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
7827 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{user_options} a
7828 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, @var{boot_addr0} and
7829 @var{boot_addr1} two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
7830 @end deffn
7831
7832 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x optcr2_write} num optcr2
7833 Writes FLASH_OPTCR2 options. Warning: Clearing PCROPi bits requires a full mass erase!
7834 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{optcr2} a 32-bit word.
7835 @end deffn
7836 @end deffn
7837
7838 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32h7x}
7839 All members of the STM32H7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7840 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M7 core.
7841 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7842 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7843
7844 @example
7845 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7846 @end example
7847
7848 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7849 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7850 the flash driver.
7851
7852 @example
7853 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7854 @end example
7855
7856 Some stm32h7x-specific commands are defined:
7857
7858 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x lock} num
7859 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7860 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7861 @end deffn
7862
7863 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x unlock} num
7864 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7865 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7866 @end deffn
7867
7868 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x mass_erase} num
7869 Mass erases the entire stm32h7x device.
7870 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7871 @end deffn
7872
7873 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x option_read} num reg_offset
7874 Reads an option byte register from the stm32h7x device.
7875 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7876 is the register offset of the option byte to read from the used bank registers' base.
7877 For example: in STM32H74x/H75x the bank 1 registers' base is 0x52002000 and 0x52002100 for bank 2.
7878
7879 Example usage:
7880 @example
7881 # read OPTSR_CUR
7882 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x1c
7883 # read WPSN_CUR1R
7884 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x38
7885 # read WPSN_CUR2R
7886 stm32h7x option_read 1 0x38
7887 @end example
7888 @end deffn
7889
7890 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x option_write} num reg_offset value [reg_mask]
7891 Writes an option byte register of the stm32h7x device.
7892 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7893 is the register offset of the option byte to write from the used bank register base,
7894 and @var{reg_mask} is the mask to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1'
7895 will be touched).
7896
7897 Example usage:
7898 @example
7899 # swap bank 1 and bank 2 in dual bank devices
7900 # by setting SWAP_BANK_OPT bit in OPTSR_PRG
7901 stm32h7x option_write 0 0x20 0x8000000 0x8000000
7902 @end example
7903 @end deffn
7904 @end deffn
7905
7906 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32lx}
7907 All members of the STM32L0 and STM32L1 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7908 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
7909 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7910 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7911
7912 @example
7913 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7914 @end example
7915
7916 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7917 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7918 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
7919 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
7920 second bank.
7921
7922 @example
7923 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7924 @end example
7925
7926 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
7927
7928 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx lock} num
7929 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7930 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7931 @end deffn
7932
7933 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx unlock} num
7934 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7935 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7936 @end deffn
7937
7938 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx mass_erase} num
7939 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
7940 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
7941 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
7942 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7943 @end deffn
7944 @end deffn
7945
7946 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32l4x}
7947 All members of the STM32 G0, G4, L4, L4+, L5, U5, WB and WL
7948 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics include internal flash
7949 and use ARM Cortex-M0+, M4 and M33 cores.
7950 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7951 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7952
7953 @example
7954 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7955 @end example
7956
7957 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
7958 as per the following example.
7959 @example
7960 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x1FFF7000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7961 @end example
7962
7963 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x otp} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7964 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7965 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7966 @end deffn
7967
7968 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7969 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7970 the flash driver. However, specifying a wrong value might lead to a completely
7971 wrong flash layout, so this feature must be used carefully.
7972
7973 @example
7974 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x08000000 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7975 @end example
7976
7977 Some stm32l4x-specific commands are defined:
7978
7979 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x lock} num
7980 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7981 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7982
7983 @emph{Note:} To apply the protection change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7984 @end deffn
7985
7986 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x unlock} num
7987 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7988 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7989
7990 @emph{Note:} To apply the protection change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7991 @end deffn
7992
7993 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x mass_erase} num
7994 Mass erases the entire stm32l4x device.
7995 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7996 @end deffn
7997
7998 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_read} num reg_offset
7999 Reads an option byte register from the stm32l4x device.
8000 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
8001 is the register offset of the Option byte to read.
8002
8003 For example to read the FLASH_OPTR register:
8004 @example
8005 stm32l4x option_read 0 0x20
8006 # Option Register (for STM32L4x): <0x40022020> = 0xffeff8aa
8007 # Option Register (for STM32WBx): <0x58004020> = ...
8008 # The correct flash base address will be used automatically
8009 @end example
8010
8011 The above example will read out the FLASH_OPTR register which contains the RDP
8012 option byte, Watchdog configuration, BOR level etc.
8013 @end deffn
8014
8015 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_write} num reg_offset reg_mask
8016 Write an option byte register of the stm32l4x device.
8017 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
8018 is the register offset of the Option byte to write, and @var{reg_mask} is the mask
8019 to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1' will be touched).
8020
8021 @emph{Note:} To apply the option bytes change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
8022
8023 For example to write the WRP1AR option bytes:
8024 @example
8025 stm32l4x option_write 0 0x28 0x00FF0000 0x00FF00FF
8026 @end example
8027
8028 The above example will write the WRP1AR option register configuring the Write protection
8029 Area A for bank 1. The above example set WRP1AR_END=255, WRP1AR_START=0.
8030 This will effectively write protect all sectors in flash bank 1.
8031 @end deffn
8032
8033 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x wrp_info} num [device_bank]
8034 List the protected areas using WRP.
8035 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
8036 @var{device_bank} parameter is optional, possible values 'bank1' or 'bank2',
8037 if not specified, the command will display the whole flash protected areas.
8038
8039 @b{Note:} @var{device_bank} is different from banks created using @code{flash bank}.
8040 Devices supported in this flash driver, can have main flash memory organized
8041 in single or dual-banks mode.
8042 Thus the usage of @var{device_bank} is meaningful only in dual-bank mode, to get
8043 write protected areas in a specific @var{device_bank}
8044
8045 @end deffn
8046
8047 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_load} num
8048 Forces a re-load of the option byte registers. Will cause a system reset of the device.
8049 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
8050 @end deffn
8051
8052 @deffn Command {stm32l4x trustzone} num [@option{enable} | @option{disable}]
8053 Enables or disables Global TrustZone Security, using the TZEN option bit.
8054 If neither @option{enabled} nor @option{disable} are specified, the command will display
8055 the TrustZone status.
8056 @emph{Note:} This command works only with devices with TrustZone, eg. STM32L5.
8057 @emph{Note:} This command will perform an OBL_Launch after modifying the TZEN.
8058 @end deffn
8059 @end deffn
8060
8061 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str7x}
8062 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
8063 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
8064 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
8065 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
8066
8067 @example
8068 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
8069 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
8070 @end example
8071
8072 @deffn {Command} {str7x disable_jtag} bank
8073 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
8074 for the specified flash bank.
8075 @end deffn
8076 @end deffn
8077
8078 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str9x}
8079 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
8080 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
8081 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
8082 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
8083
8084 @example
8085 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
8086 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
8087 @end example
8088
8089 @deffn {Command} {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
8090 Configures the str9 flash controller.
8091 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
8092
8093 @itemize @bullet
8094 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
8095 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
8096 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
8097 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
8098 @end itemize
8099 @end deffn
8100
8101 @end deffn
8102
8103 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str9xpec}
8104 @cindex str9xpec
8105
8106 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
8107 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
8108 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
8109 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
8110
8111 Here is some background info to help
8112 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
8113 the str9:
8114 @enumerate
8115 @item
8116 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
8117 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
8118 @item
8119 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
8120 ISC compliant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
8121 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
8122 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
8123 @end enumerate
8124
8125 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
8126 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
8127 configured for flash bank 0.
8128 @example
8129 # assert srst, we do not want core running
8130 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
8131 adapter assert srst
8132 # turn off target polling
8133 poll off
8134 # disable str9 core
8135 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
8136 # read option bytes
8137 str9xpec options_read 0
8138 # re-enable str9 core
8139 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
8140 poll on
8141 reset halt
8142 @end example
8143 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
8144 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
8145 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
8146 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
8147
8148 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
8149
8150 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
8151 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
8152 @end deffn
8153
8154 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
8155 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
8156 directly to the embedded flash controller.
8157 @end deffn
8158
8159 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec lock} num
8160 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
8161 erase the device.
8162 @end deffn
8163
8164 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec part_id} num
8165 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
8166 @end deffn
8167
8168 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
8169 Configure str9 boot bank.
8170 @end deffn
8171
8172 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
8173 Configure str9 lvd source.
8174 @end deffn
8175
8176 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
8177 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
8178 @end deffn
8179
8180 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
8181 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
8182 @end deffn
8183
8184 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_read} num
8185 Read str9 option bytes.
8186 @end deffn
8187
8188 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_write} num
8189 Write str9 option bytes.
8190 @end deffn
8191
8192 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec unlock} num
8193 unlock str9 device.
8194 @end deffn
8195
8196 @end deffn
8197
8198 @deffn {Flash Driver} {swm050}
8199 @cindex swm050
8200 All members of the swm050 microcontroller family from Foshan Synwit Tech.
8201
8202 @example
8203 flash bank $_FLASHNAME swm050 0x0 0x2000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
8204 @end example
8205
8206 One swm050-specific command is defined:
8207
8208 @deffn {Command} {swm050 mass_erase} bank_id
8209 Erases the entire flash bank.
8210 @end deffn
8211
8212 @end deffn
8213
8214
8215 @deffn {Flash Driver} {tms470}
8216 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
8217 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
8218 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
8219
8220 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
8221
8222 @deffn {Command} {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
8223 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
8224 @end deffn
8225
8226 @deffn {Command} {tms470 osc_megahertz} clock_mhz
8227 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
8228 @end deffn
8229
8230 @deffn {Command} {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
8231 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
8232 the flash clock.
8233 @end deffn
8234 @end deffn
8235
8236 @deffn {Flash Driver} {w600}
8237 W60x series Wi-Fi SoC from WinnerMicro
8238 are designed with ARM Cortex-M3 and have 1M Byte QFLASH inside.
8239 The @var{w600} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
8240 correct bank config.
8241
8242 @example
8243 flash bank $_FLASHNAME w600 0x08000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAMEs
8244 @end example
8245 @end deffn
8246
8247 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xmc1xxx}
8248 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
8249 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
8250 @end deffn
8251
8252 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xmc4xxx}
8253 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
8254 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
8255
8256 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
8257
8258 @deffn {Command} {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
8259 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
8260 @end deffn
8261
8262 @deffn {Command} {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
8263 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
8264 @end deffn
8265
8266 @end deffn
8267
8268 @section NAND Flash Commands
8269 @cindex NAND
8270
8271 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
8272 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
8273 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
8274
8275 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
8276 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
8277 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
8278 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
8279 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
8280 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
8281
8282 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
8283 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
8284 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
8285 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
8286 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
8287 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
8288 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
8289 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
8290 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
8291 with techniques such as wear leveling.
8292
8293 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
8294 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
8295 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
8296 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
8297 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
8298 every 512 bytes of data.
8299
8300 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
8301 OpenOCD includes the appropriate kind of ECC. For example,
8302 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
8303 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
8304 ECC mode is used.
8305
8306 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
8307 @enumerate
8308 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
8309 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
8310 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
8311 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
8312 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
8313 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
8314 to access that device.
8315 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
8316 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
8317 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
8318 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
8319 de-brick a board.
8320 @end enumerate
8321
8322 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
8323 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
8324 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
8325 are only 32 bits wide.
8326 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
8327 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
8328 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
8329 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
8330
8331 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
8332 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
8333 @cindex NAND configuration
8334
8335 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
8336 plus some additional configuration that's done after
8337 OpenOCD has initialized.
8338
8339 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
8340 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
8341 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
8342 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
8343 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
8344 they were a single (larger) device.
8345 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
8346 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
8347
8348 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
8349 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
8350 configuration files, not interactively.
8351
8352 @itemize @bullet
8353 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
8354 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
8355 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
8356 associated with the NAND device being declared.
8357 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
8358 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
8359 commands to the NAND controller.
8360 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
8361 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
8362 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
8363 for more information.
8364 @end itemize
8365 @end deffn
8366
8367 @deffn {Command} {nand list}
8368 Prints a summary of each device declared
8369 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
8370 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
8371 @example
8372 > nand list
8373 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
8374 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
8375 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
8376 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
8377 >
8378 @end example
8379 @end deffn
8380
8381 @deffn {Command} {nand probe} num
8382 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
8383 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
8384 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8385 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
8386 it with most other NAND commands.
8387 @end deffn
8388
8389 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
8390
8391 @deffn {Command} {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
8392 @cindex NAND reading
8393 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
8394 starting at the specified offset.
8395 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8396
8397 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
8398 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
8399
8400 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
8401 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
8402 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
8403
8404 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
8405 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
8406 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
8407 method which handled that error correction.
8408
8409 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
8410 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
8411 @itemize @bullet
8412 @item no oob_* parameter
8413 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
8414 @item @code{oob_raw}
8415 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
8416 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
8417 spare areas associated with each data page.
8418 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
8419 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
8420 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
8421 @item @code{oob_only}
8422 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
8423 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
8424 spare areas associated with each data page.
8425 @end itemize
8426 @end deffn
8427
8428 @deffn {Command} {nand erase} num [offset length]
8429 @cindex NAND erasing
8430 @cindex NAND programming
8431 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
8432 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
8433 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
8434 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
8435 If those parameters are not specified,
8436 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
8437 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8438
8439 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
8440 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
8441 block marker.
8442 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
8443 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
8444 @end deffn
8445
8446 @deffn {Command} {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
8447 @cindex NAND writing
8448 @cindex NAND programming
8449 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
8450 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
8451 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
8452 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8453
8454 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
8455 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
8456
8457 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
8458 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
8459 past the end of the device.
8460 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
8461 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
8462 if that's being written.)
8463
8464 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
8465 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
8466 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
8467
8468 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
8469 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
8470 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
8471 @itemize @bullet
8472 @item no oob_* parameter
8473 @*File has only page data, which is written.
8474 If raw access is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
8475 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
8476 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
8477 with hardware-computed ECC data.
8478 @item @code{oob_only}
8479 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
8480 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
8481 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
8482 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
8483 @item @code{oob_raw}
8484 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
8485 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
8486 un-altered OOB.
8487 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
8488 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
8489 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
8490 @item @code{oob_softecc}
8491 @*File has only page data, which is written.
8492 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
8493 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
8494 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
8495 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
8496 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
8497 @*File has only page data, which is written.
8498 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
8499 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
8500 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
8501 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
8502 @end itemize
8503 @end deffn
8504
8505 @deffn {Command} {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
8506 @cindex NAND verification
8507 @cindex NAND programming
8508 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
8509 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
8510 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8511
8512 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
8513 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
8514
8515 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
8516 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
8517 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
8518 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
8519 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
8520
8521 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
8522 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
8523 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
8524
8525 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
8526 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
8527 hardware-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
8528 be removed in a future release.
8529 @end deffn
8530
8531 @subsection Other NAND commands
8532 @cindex NAND other commands
8533
8534 @deffn {Command} {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
8535 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
8536 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
8537 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
8538 continues for @var{length} bytes.
8539 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
8540 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
8541 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8542
8543 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
8544 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
8545 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
8546 @end deffn
8547
8548 @deffn {Command} {nand info} num
8549 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8550 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
8551 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
8552 status for each block.
8553 @end deffn
8554
8555 @deffn {Command} {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8556 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
8557 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8558
8559 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
8560 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
8561 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
8562 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
8563 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
8564
8565 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
8566 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
8567 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
8568 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
8569 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
8570 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
8571 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
8572 @end deffn
8573
8574 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
8575 @subsection NAND Driver List
8576 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
8577 driver-specific options and behaviors.
8578 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
8579
8580 @deffn {NAND Driver} {at91sam9}
8581 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
8582 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
8583 address of the ECC controller.
8584 @example
8585 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
8586 @end example
8587 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
8588 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
8589 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
8590 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
8591 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
8592 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
8593 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
8594 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8595 @end deffn
8596 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
8597 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
8598 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8599 @end deffn
8600
8601 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
8602 properly configured for input or output.
8603 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
8604 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
8605 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
8606 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
8607 @end deffn
8608 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
8609 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
8610 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
8611 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
8612 @end deffn
8613 @end deffn
8614
8615 @deffn {NAND Driver} {davinci}
8616 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
8617 chips from Texas Instruments.
8618 It takes three extra parameters:
8619 address of the NAND chip;
8620 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
8621 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
8622 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
8623 @example
8624 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
8625 @end example
8626 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
8627 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
8628 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
8629 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
8630 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
8631 @end deffn
8632
8633 @deffn {NAND Driver} {lpc3180}
8634 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
8635 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
8636 @deffn {Command} {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
8637 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
8638 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
8639 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8640 @end deffn
8641
8642 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
8643 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
8644 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
8645 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
8646 @end deffn
8647 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
8648
8649 @deffn {NAND Driver} {mx3}
8650 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
8651 should work for this chip as well.
8652 @end deffn
8653
8654 @deffn {NAND Driver} {mxc}
8655 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
8656 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
8657 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
8658 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
8659 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
8660 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
8661 @example
8662 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
8663 @end example
8664 @deffn {Command} {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
8665 Turns on/off bad block information swapping from main area,
8666 without parameter query status.
8667 @end deffn
8668 @end deffn
8669
8670 @deffn {NAND Driver} {orion}
8671 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
8672 parameter: the address of the controller.
8673 @example
8674 nand device orion 0xd8000000
8675 @end example
8676 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
8677 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
8678 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
8679 change any behavior.
8680 @end deffn
8681
8682 @deffn {NAND Driver} {s3c2410}
8683 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2412}
8684 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2440}
8685 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2443}
8686 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c6400}
8687 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
8688 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
8689 specialized commands.
8690 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
8691 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
8692 change any behavior.
8693 @end deffn
8694
8695 @node Flash Programming
8696 @chapter Flash Programming
8697
8698 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
8699 Programming can be achieved by either using @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
8700 or using the commands given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
8701
8702 @*To simplify using the flash commands directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
8703 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
8704
8705 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be performed.
8706 @enumerate
8707 @item 'init' is executed.
8708 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
8709 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
8710 @item If the @option{preverify} parameter is given, the target is "verified" first and only flashed if this fails.
8711 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
8712 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
8713 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
8714 @end enumerate
8715
8716 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
8717
8718 @example
8719 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
8720 # are optional parameters
8721 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
8722 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
8723
8724 # binary files need the flash address passing
8725 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
8726 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
8727 @end example
8728
8729 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
8730 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
8731 @cindex PLD
8732 @cindex FPGA
8733
8734 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
8735 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
8736 OpenOCD can support programming them.
8737 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
8738 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
8739 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
8740 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
8741
8742 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
8743
8744 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
8745 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
8746 Also, each such PLD requires a driver. PLD drivers may also be needed to program
8747 SPI flash connected to the FPGA to store the bitstream (@xref{jtagspi} for details).
8748
8749 They are referenced by the name which was given when the pld was created or
8750 the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command.
8751 New PLDs are defined by @command{pld create pld_name driver_name -chain-position tap_name [driver_options]}.
8752
8753 @deffn {Config Command} {pld create} pld_name driver_name -chain-position tap_name [driver_options]
8754 Creates a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
8755 assigning @var{pld_name} for further reference.
8756 @code{-chain-position} @var{tap_name} names the TAP
8757 used to access this target.
8758 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its behavior.
8759 @end deffn
8760
8761 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
8762 List the known PLDs with their name.
8763 @end deffn
8764
8765 @deffn {Command} {pld load} pld_name filename
8766 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{pld_name}.
8767 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
8768 @end deffn
8769
8770 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
8771
8772 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
8773 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
8774 that particular type of PLD.
8775
8776 @deffn {FPGA Driver} {virtex2} [@option{-no_jstart}]
8777 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
8778 This driver can also be used to load Series3, Series6, Series7 and Zynq 7000 devices.
8779 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
8780
8781 If @var{-no_jstart} is given, the JSTART instruction is not used after
8782 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
8783 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
8784
8785 @example
8786 openocd -f board/digilent_zedboard.cfg -c "init" \
8787 -c "pld load 0 zedboard_bitstream.bit"
8788 @end example
8789
8790
8791 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} pld_name
8792 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
8793 for FPGA @var{pld_name}.
8794 @end deffn
8795
8796 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 set_instr_codes} pld_name cfg_out cfg_in jprogb jstart jshutdown [user1 [user2 [user3 [user4]]]]
8797 Change values for boundary scan instructions. Default are values for Virtex 2, devices Virtex 4/5/6 and
8798 SSI devices are using different values.
8799 @var{pld_name} is the name of the pld device.
8800 @var{cfg_out} is the value used to select CFG_OUT instruction.
8801 @var{cfg_in} is the value used to select CFG_IN instruction.
8802 @var{jprogb} is the value used to select JPROGRAM instruction.
8803 @var{jstart} is the value used to select JSTART instruction.
8804 @var{jshutdown} is the value used to select JSHUTDOWN instruction.
8805 @var{user1} to @var{user4} are the intruction used to select the user registers USER1 to USER4.
8806 @end deffn
8807
8808 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 set_user_codes} pld_name user1 [user2 [user3 [user4]]]
8809 Change values for boundary scan instructions selecting the registers USER1 to USER4.
8810 Description of the arguments can be found at command @command{virtex2 set_instr_codes}.
8811 @end deffn
8812
8813 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 refresh} pld_name
8814 Load the bitstream from external memory for FPGA @var{pld_name}. A.k.a. program.
8815 @end deffn
8816 @end deffn
8817
8818
8819
8820 @deffn {FPGA Driver} {lattice} [@option{-family} <name>]
8821 The FGPA families ECP2, ECP3, ECP5, Certus and CertusPro by Lattice are supported.
8822 This driver can be used to load the bitstream into the FPGA or read the status register and read/write the usercode register.
8823
8824 For the option @option{-family} @var{name} is one of @var{ecp2 ecp3 ecp5 certus}. This is needed when the JTAG ID of the device is not known by openocd (newer NX devices).
8825
8826 @deffn {Command} {lattice read_status} pld_name
8827 Reads and displays the status register
8828 for FPGA @var{pld_name}.
8829 @end deffn
8830
8831 @deffn {Command} {lattice read_user} pld_name
8832 Reads and displays the user register
8833 for FPGA @var{pld_name}.
8834 @end deffn
8835
8836 @deffn {Command} {lattice write_user} pld_name val
8837 Writes the user register.
8838 for FPGA @var{pld_name} with value @var{val}.
8839 @end deffn
8840
8841 @deffn {Command} {lattice set_preload} pld_name length
8842 Set the length of the register for the preload. This is needed when the JTAG ID of the device is not known by openocd (newer NX devices).
8843 The load command for the FPGA @var{pld_name} will use a length for the preload of @var{length}.
8844 @end deffn
8845
8846 @deffn {Command} {lattice refresh} pld_name
8847 Load the bitstream from external memory for FPGA @var{pld_name}. A.k.a program.
8848 @end deffn
8849 @end deffn
8850
8851
8852 @deffn {FPGA Driver} {efinix} [@option{-family} <name>]
8853 Both families (Trion and Titanium) sold by Efinix are supported as both use the same protocol for In-System Configuration.
8854 This driver can be used to load the bitstream into the FPGA.
8855 For the option @option{-family} @var{name} is one of @var{trion|titanium}.
8856 @end deffn
8857
8858
8859 @deffn {FPGA Driver} {intel} [@option{-family} <name>]
8860 This driver can be used to load the bitstream into Intel (former Altera) FPGAs.
8861 The families Cyclone III, Cyclone IV, Cyclone V, Cyclone 10, Arria II are supported.
8862 @c Arria V and Arria 10, MAX II, MAX V, MAX10)
8863
8864 For the option @option{-family} @var{name} is one of @var{cycloneiii cycloneiv cyclonev cyclone10 arriaii}.
8865 This is needed when the JTAG ID of the device is ambiguous (same ID is used for chips in different families).
8866
8867 As input file format the driver supports a '.rbf' (raw bitstream file) file. The '.rbf' file can be generated
8868 from a '.sof' file with @verb{|quartus_cpf -c blinker.sof blinker.rbf|}
8869
8870 Creates a new PLD device, an FPGA of the Cyclone III family, using the TAP named @verb{|cycloneiii.tap|}:
8871 @example
8872 pld create cycloneiii.pld intel -chain-position cycloneiii.tap -family cycloneiii
8873 @end example
8874
8875 @deffn {Command} {intel set_bscan} pld_name len
8876 Set boundary scan register length of FPGA @var{pld_name} to @var{len}. This is needed because the
8877 length can vary between chips with the same JTAG ID.
8878 @end deffn
8879
8880 @deffn {Command} {intel set_check_pos} pld_name pos
8881 Selects the position @var{pos} in the boundary-scan register. The bit at this
8882 position is checked after loading the bitstream and must be '1', which is the case when no error occurred.
8883 With a value of -1 for @var{pos} the check will be omitted.
8884 @end deffn
8885 @end deffn
8886
8887
8888 @deffn {FPGA Driver} {gowin}
8889 This driver can be used to load the bitstream into FPGAs from Gowin.
8890 It is possible to program the SRAM. Programming the flash is not supported.
8891 The files @verb{|.fs|} and @verb{|.bin|} generated by Gowin FPGA Designer are supported.
8892
8893 @deffn {Command} {gowin read_status} pld_name
8894 Reads and displays the status register
8895 for FPGA @var{pld_name}.
8896 @end deffn
8897
8898 @deffn {Command} {gowin read_user} pld_name
8899 Reads and displays the user register
8900 for FPGA @var{pld_name}.
8901 @end deffn
8902
8903 @deffn {Command} {gowin refresh} pld_name
8904 Load the bitstream from external memory for
8905 FPGA @var{pld_name}. A.k.a. reload.
8906 @end deffn
8907 @end deffn
8908
8909
8910 @deffn {FPGA Driver} {gatemate}
8911 This driver can be used to load the bitstream into GateMate FPGAs form CologneChip.
8912 The files @verb{|.bit|} and @verb{|.cfg|} both generated by p_r tool from CologneChip are supported.
8913 @end deffn
8914
8915
8916 @node General Commands
8917 @chapter General Commands
8918 @cindex commands
8919
8920 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
8921 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
8922 commands are documented elsewhere.
8923
8924 Intent:
8925 @itemize @bullet
8926 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
8927 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
8928 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programmatically,
8929 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
8930
8931 @item @b{From the human}
8932 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
8933 or via GDB (default port 3333).
8934
8935 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
8936 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
8937 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
8938
8939 @item @b{Machine Interface}
8940 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
8941 port is 6666.
8942 @end itemize
8943
8944
8945 @section Server Commands
8946
8947 @deffn {Command} {exit}
8948 Exits the current telnet session.
8949 @end deffn
8950
8951 @deffn {Command} {help} [string]
8952 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
8953 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
8954 Not every command provides helptext.
8955
8956 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
8957 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
8958 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
8959 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
8960 @end deffn
8961
8962 @deffn {Command} {usage} [string]
8963 With no parameters, prints usage text for all commands. Otherwise,
8964 prints all usage text of which command, help text, and usage text
8965 containing @var{string}.
8966 Not every command provides helptext.
8967 @end deffn
8968
8969 @deffn {Command} {sleep} msec [@option{busy}]
8970 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
8971 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
8972 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
8973 Useful in connection with script files
8974 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
8975 @end deffn
8976
8977 @deffn {Command} {shutdown} [@option{error}]
8978 Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
8979 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
8980 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
8981
8982 If user types CTRL-C or kills OpenOCD, the command @command{shutdown}
8983 will be automatically executed to cause OpenOCD to exit.
8984
8985 It is possible to specify, in the TCL list @var{pre_shutdown_commands} , a
8986 set of commands to be automatically executed before @command{shutdown} , e.g.:
8987 @example
8988 lappend pre_shutdown_commands @{echo "Goodbye, my friend ..."@}
8989 lappend pre_shutdown_commands @{echo "see you soon !"@}
8990 @end example
8991 The commands in the list will be executed (in the same order they occupy
8992 in the list) before OpenOCD exits. If one of the commands in the list
8993 fails, then the remaining commands are not executed anymore while OpenOCD
8994 will proceed to quit.
8995 @end deffn
8996
8997 @anchor{debuglevel}
8998 @deffn {Command} {debug_level} [n]
8999 @cindex message level
9000 Display debug level.
9001 If @var{n} (from 0..4) is provided, then set it to that level.
9002 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
9003 Level 0 is error messages only;
9004 level 1 adds warnings;
9005 level 2 adds informational messages;
9006 level 3 adds debugging messages;
9007 and level 4 adds verbose low-level debug messages.
9008 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
9009 the command line along with the location of that log
9010 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
9011 @xref{Running}.
9012 @end deffn
9013
9014 @deffn {Command} {echo} [-n] message
9015 Logs a message at "user" priority.
9016 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
9017 @example
9018 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
9019 @end example
9020 @end deffn
9021
9022 @deffn {Command} {log_output} [filename | "default"]
9023 Redirect logging to @var{filename} or set it back to default output;
9024 the default log output channel is stderr.
9025 @end deffn
9026
9027 @deffn {Command} {add_script_search_dir} [directory]
9028 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
9029 @end deffn
9030
9031 @deffn {Config Command} {bindto} [@var{name}]
9032 Specify hostname or IPv4 address on which to listen for incoming
9033 TCP/IP connections. By default, OpenOCD will listen on the loopback
9034 interface only. If your network environment is safe, @code{bindto
9035 0.0.0.0} can be used to cover all available interfaces.
9036 @end deffn
9037
9038 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
9039 @section Target State handling
9040 @cindex reset
9041 @cindex halt
9042 @cindex target initialization
9043
9044 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
9045 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
9046 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
9047 a current target which is used to perform the
9048 various operations. The current target may be changed
9049 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
9050 target which should become current.
9051
9052 @deffn {Command} {reg} [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
9053 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
9054 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
9055 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
9056 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
9057
9058 @emph{With no arguments}:
9059 list all available registers for the current target,
9060 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
9061 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
9062 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
9063 are flagged as such.
9064
9065 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
9066 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
9067 bypassing any internal cache.
9068
9069 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
9070 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
9071 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
9072 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
9073 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
9074 relevant module will flush such values.
9075
9076 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
9077 Debug and trace infrastructure:
9078
9079 @example
9080 > reg
9081 ===== ARM registers
9082 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
9083 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
9084 (2) r2 (/32)
9085 ...
9086 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
9087 >
9088 @end example
9089 @end deffn
9090
9091 @deffn {Command} {set_reg} dict
9092 Set register values of the target.
9093
9094 @itemize
9095 @item @var{dict} ... Tcl dictionary with pairs of register names and values.
9096 @end itemize
9097
9098 For example, the following command sets the value 0 to the program counter (pc)
9099 register and 0x1000 to the stack pointer (sp) register:
9100
9101 @example
9102 set_reg @{pc 0 sp 0x1000@}
9103 @end example
9104 @end deffn
9105
9106 @deffn {Command} {get_reg} [-force] list
9107 Get register values from the target and return them as Tcl dictionary with pairs
9108 of register names and values.
9109 If option "-force" is set, the register values are read directly from the
9110 target, bypassing any caching.
9111
9112 @itemize
9113 @item @var{list} ... List of register names
9114 @end itemize
9115
9116 For example, the following command retrieves the values from the program
9117 counter (pc) and stack pointer (sp) register:
9118
9119 @example
9120 get_reg @{pc sp@}
9121 @end example
9122 @end deffn
9123
9124 @deffn {Command} {write_memory} address width data ['phys']
9125 This function provides an efficient way to write to the target memory from a Tcl
9126 script.
9127
9128 @itemize
9129 @item @var{address} ... target memory address
9130 @item @var{width} ... memory access bit size, can be 8, 16, 32 or 64
9131 @item @var{data} ... Tcl list with the elements to write
9132 @item ['phys'] ... treat the memory address as physical instead of virtual address
9133 @end itemize
9134
9135 For example, the following command writes two 32 bit words into the target
9136 memory at address 0x20000000:
9137
9138 @example
9139 write_memory 0x20000000 32 @{0xdeadbeef 0x00230500@}
9140 @end example
9141 @end deffn
9142
9143 @deffn {Command} {read_memory} address width count ['phys']
9144 This function provides an efficient way to read the target memory from a Tcl
9145 script.
9146 A Tcl list containing the requested memory elements is returned by this function.
9147
9148 @itemize
9149 @item @var{address} ... target memory address
9150 @item @var{width} ... memory access bit size, can be 8, 16, 32 or 64
9151 @item @var{count} ... number of elements to read
9152 @item ['phys'] ... treat the memory address as physical instead of virtual address
9153 @end itemize
9154
9155 For example, the following command reads two 32 bit words from the target
9156 memory at address 0x20000000:
9157
9158 @example
9159 read_memory 0x20000000 32 2
9160 @end example
9161 @end deffn
9162
9163 @deffn {Command} {halt} [ms]
9164 @deffnx {Command} {wait_halt} [ms]
9165 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
9166 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
9167 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
9168 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
9169 (and enter debug mode).
9170 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
9171
9172 @quotation Warning
9173 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
9174 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
9175 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
9176 power mode by gating the core clock;
9177 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
9178
9179 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
9180 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
9181 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
9182 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
9183 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
9184 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
9185
9186 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
9187 work with a JTAG debugger.
9188 Tasking environments generally have idle loops where the body is the
9189 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
9190 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
9191 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
9192 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
9193 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
9194 @end quotation
9195
9196 @end deffn
9197
9198 @deffn {Command} {resume} [address]
9199 Resume the target at its current code position,
9200 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
9201 @end deffn
9202
9203 @deffn {Command} {step} [address]
9204 Single-step the target at its current code position,
9205 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
9206 @end deffn
9207
9208 @anchor{resetcommand}
9209 @deffn {Command} {reset}
9210 @deffnx {Command} {reset run}
9211 @deffnx {Command} {reset halt}
9212 @deffnx {Command} {reset init}
9213 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
9214 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
9215 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
9216
9217 The optional parameter specifies what should
9218 happen after the reset.
9219 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
9220 The other options will not work on all systems.
9221 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
9222
9223 @itemize @minus
9224 @item @b{run} Let the target run
9225 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
9226 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
9227 @end itemize
9228 @end deffn
9229
9230 @deffn {Command} {soft_reset_halt}
9231 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
9232 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
9233 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
9234 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
9235 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
9236 state.
9237 @end deffn
9238
9239 @deffn {Command} {adapter assert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
9240 @deffnx {Command} {adapter deassert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
9241 Set values of reset signals.
9242 Without parameters returns current status of the signals.
9243 The @var{signal} parameter values may be
9244 @option{srst}, indicating that srst signal is to be asserted or deasserted,
9245 @option{trst}, indicating that trst signal is to be asserted or deasserted.
9246
9247 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
9248 to configure how the board and the adapter treat these two
9249 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
9250 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
9251 Trying to assert a signal that is not present triggers an error.
9252 If a signal is present on the adapter and not specified in the command,
9253 the signal will not be modified.
9254
9255 @quotation Note
9256 TRST is specially handled.
9257 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
9258 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
9259 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
9260 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
9261 instead of the TRST signal.
9262 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
9263 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
9264 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
9265 with handlers for that event.
9266 @end quotation
9267 @end deffn
9268
9269 @anchor{memoryaccess}
9270 @section Memory access commands
9271 @cindex memory access
9272
9273 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
9274 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
9275 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
9276 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
9277
9278 @enumerate
9279 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
9280 to change the current target.
9281 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
9282 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
9283 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
9284 @end enumerate
9285
9286 @deffn {Command} {mdd} [phys] addr [count]
9287 @deffnx {Command} {mdw} [phys] addr [count]
9288 @deffnx {Command} {mdh} [phys] addr [count]
9289 @deffnx {Command} {mdb} [phys] addr [count]
9290 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
9291 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
9292 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
9293 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
9294 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
9295 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
9296 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
9297 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
9298 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
9299 (If you want to process the data instead of displaying it,
9300 see the @code{read_memory} primitives.)
9301 @end deffn
9302
9303 @deffn {Command} {mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
9304 @deffnx {Command} {mww} [phys] addr word [count]
9305 @deffnx {Command} {mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
9306 @deffnx {Command} {mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
9307 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
9308 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
9309 at the specified address @var{addr}.
9310 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
9311 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
9312 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
9313 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
9314 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
9315 @end deffn
9316
9317 @anchor{imageaccess}
9318 @section Image loading commands
9319 @cindex image loading
9320 @cindex image dumping
9321
9322 @deffn {Command} {dump_image} filename address size
9323 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
9324 binary file named @var{filename}.
9325 @end deffn
9326
9327 @deffn {Command} {fast_load}
9328 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
9329 current target. Must be preceded by fast_load_image.
9330 @end deffn
9331
9332 @deffn {Command} {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
9333 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
9334 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
9335 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
9336 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
9337 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
9338 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
9339 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
9340 separately.
9341 @end deffn
9342
9343 @deffn {Command} {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
9344 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
9345 The file format may optionally be specified
9346 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
9347 In addition the following arguments may be specified:
9348 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
9349 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
9350 @example
9351 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
9352 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
9353 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
9354 load_image $fname [expr @{$address - $foffset@}] bin \
9355 $address $length
9356 @}
9357 @end example
9358 @end deffn
9359
9360 @deffn {Command} {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
9361 Displays image section sizes and addresses
9362 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
9363 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
9364 The file format may optionally be specified
9365 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
9366 @end deffn
9367
9368 @deffn {Command} {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
9369 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
9370 The file format may optionally be specified
9371 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
9372 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
9373 @end deffn
9374
9375 @deffn {Command} {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
9376 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
9377 The file format may optionally be specified
9378 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
9379 This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
9380 @end deffn
9381
9382
9383 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
9384 @cindex breakpoint
9385 @cindex watchpoint
9386
9387 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
9388 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
9389 watchpoints.
9390 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
9391
9392 @deffn {Command} {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
9393 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
9394 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
9395 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
9396 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
9397 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
9398
9399 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
9400 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
9401 @end deffn
9402
9403 @deffn {Command} {rbp} @option{all} | address
9404 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address} or all breakpoints.
9405 @end deffn
9406
9407 @deffn {Command} {rwp} @option{all} | address
9408 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address} or all watchpoints.
9409 @end deffn
9410
9411 @deffn {Command} {wp} [address length [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
9412 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
9413 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
9414 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
9415 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
9416 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
9417 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
9418 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
9419 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
9420 @end deffn
9421
9422
9423 @section Real Time Transfer (RTT)
9424
9425 Real Time Transfer (RTT) is an interface specified by SEGGER based on basic
9426 memory reads and writes to transfer data bidirectionally between target and host.
9427 The specification is independent of the target architecture.
9428 Every target that supports so called "background memory access", which means
9429 that the target memory can be accessed by the debugger while the target is
9430 running, can be used.
9431 This interface is especially of interest for targets without
9432 Serial Wire Output (SWO), such as ARM Cortex-M0, or where semihosting is not
9433 applicable because of real-time constraints.
9434
9435 @quotation Note
9436 The current implementation supports only single target devices.
9437 @end quotation
9438
9439 The data transfer between host and target device is organized through
9440 unidirectional up/down-channels for target-to-host and host-to-target
9441 communication, respectively.
9442
9443 @quotation Note
9444 The current implementation does not respect channel buffer flags.
9445 They are used to determine what happens when writing to a full buffer, for
9446 example.
9447 @end quotation
9448
9449 Channels are exposed via raw TCP/IP connections. One or more RTT servers can be
9450 assigned to each channel to make them accessible to an unlimited number
9451 of TCP/IP connections.
9452
9453 @deffn {Command} {rtt setup} address size ID
9454 Configure RTT for the currently selected target.
9455 Once RTT is started, OpenOCD searches for a control block with the
9456 identifier @var{ID} starting at the memory address @var{address} within the next
9457 @var{size} bytes.
9458 @end deffn
9459
9460 @deffn {Command} {rtt start}
9461 Start RTT.
9462 If the control block location is not known, OpenOCD starts searching for it.
9463 @end deffn
9464
9465 @deffn {Command} {rtt stop}
9466 Stop RTT.
9467 @end deffn
9468
9469 @deffn {Command} {rtt polling_interval} [interval]
9470 Display the polling interval.
9471 If @var{interval} is provided, set the polling interval.
9472 The polling interval determines (in milliseconds) how often the up-channels are
9473 checked for new data.
9474 @end deffn
9475
9476 @deffn {Command} {rtt channels}
9477 Display a list of all channels and their properties.
9478 @end deffn
9479
9480 @deffn {Command} {rtt channellist}
9481 Return a list of all channels and their properties as Tcl list.
9482 The list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
9483 @end deffn
9484
9485 @deffn {Command} {rtt server start} port channel [message]
9486 Start a TCP server on @var{port} for the channel @var{channel}. When
9487 @var{message} is not empty, it will be sent to a client when it connects.
9488 @end deffn
9489
9490 @deffn {Command} {rtt server stop} port
9491 Stop the TCP sever with port @var{port}.
9492 @end deffn
9493
9494 The following example shows how to setup RTT using the SEGGER RTT implementation
9495 on the target device.
9496
9497 @example
9498 resume
9499
9500 rtt setup 0x20000000 2048 "SEGGER RTT"
9501 rtt start
9502
9503 rtt server start 9090 0
9504 @end example
9505
9506 In this example, OpenOCD searches the control block with the ID "SEGGER RTT"
9507 starting at 0x20000000 for 2048 bytes. The RTT channel 0 is exposed through the
9508 TCP/IP port 9090.
9509
9510
9511 @section Misc Commands
9512
9513 @cindex profiling
9514 @deffn {Command} {profile} seconds filename [start end]
9515 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
9516 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
9517 Saves up to 1000000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
9518 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
9519 limit the address range.
9520 @end deffn
9521
9522 @deffn {Command} {version} [git]
9523 Returns a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
9524 With option @option{git}, it returns the git version obtained at compile time
9525 through ``git describe''.
9526 @end deffn
9527
9528 @deffn {Command} {virt2phys} virtual_address
9529 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
9530 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
9531 @end deffn
9532
9533 @deffn {Command} {add_help_text} 'command_name' 'help-string'
9534 Add or replace help text on the given @var{command_name}.
9535 @end deffn
9536
9537 @deffn {Command} {add_usage_text} 'command_name' 'help-string'
9538 Add or replace usage text on the given @var{command_name}.
9539 @end deffn
9540
9541 @node Architecture and Core Commands
9542 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
9543 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
9544 @cindex Core Specific Commands
9545
9546 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
9547 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
9548 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
9549 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
9550
9551 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
9552 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
9553 @cindex tracing
9554 @cindex ETM
9555 @cindex ETB
9556
9557 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
9558 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
9559 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
9560
9561 @itemize
9562 @item
9563 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
9564 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
9565 supports such an interface.
9566 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
9567 and trace port support.)
9568 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
9569 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
9570 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
9571 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
9572 in the board-specific configuration file.
9573 @item
9574 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
9575 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
9576 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
9577 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
9578 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
9579 @end itemize
9580
9581 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
9582
9583 @quotation Issues
9584 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
9585 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
9586
9587 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
9588 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
9589 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
9590 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
9591 dummy trace port driver}.
9592
9593 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
9594 as well as tracing only during specific states
9595 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
9596
9597 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
9598 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
9599 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
9600 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
9601 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
9602
9603 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
9604 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
9605 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
9606 this original style of JTAG access.
9607 @end quotation
9608
9609 @subsection ETM Configuration
9610 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
9611
9612 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
9613 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
9614 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
9615
9616 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
9617 which are a function of silicon capabilities (exposed later
9618 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
9619 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
9620 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
9621 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
9622 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
9623 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
9624 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
9625
9626 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
9627 or @option{demultiplexed}.
9628 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
9629
9630 @quotation Warning
9631 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
9632 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
9633 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
9634 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
9635 @end quotation
9636
9637 @quotation Note
9638 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
9639 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
9640 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
9641 what CPU activities are traced.
9642 @end quotation
9643 @end deffn
9644
9645 @deffn {Command} {etm info}
9646 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
9647 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
9648 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
9649 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
9650 @end deffn
9651
9652 @deffn {Command} {etm status}
9653 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
9654 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
9655 Did trace data overflow?
9656 Was it triggered?
9657 @end deffn
9658
9659 @deffn {Command} {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
9660 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
9661 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
9662 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
9663 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
9664
9665 @itemize
9666 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
9667 when they pass any ViewData filtering that was set up.
9668 The value is one of
9669 @option{none} (save nothing),
9670 @option{data} (save data),
9671 @option{address} (save addresses),
9672 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
9673 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
9674 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
9675 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
9676 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
9677 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
9678 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
9679 trace stream without an image of the code.
9680 @end itemize
9681 @end deffn
9682
9683 @deffn {Command} {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9684 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
9685 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
9686 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
9687 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
9688
9689 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
9690 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
9691 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
9692 @end deffn
9693
9694 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
9695
9696 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
9697 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
9698 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
9699
9700 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
9701 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
9702 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
9703 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
9704 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
9705 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
9706 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
9707
9708 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
9709
9710 @itemize
9711 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
9712 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
9713 for instruction access within that function's body.
9714 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
9715 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
9716 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
9717 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
9718 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
9719 combining one of the above models with a counter.
9720 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
9721 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
9722 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
9723 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
9724 @item @emph{... more}
9725 @end itemize
9726
9727 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
9728 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
9729
9730 @deffn {Command} {etm analyze}
9731 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
9732 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
9733 @end deffn
9734
9735 @deffn {Command} {etm dump} filename
9736 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
9737 @end deffn
9738
9739 @deffn {Command} {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
9740 Opens an image file.
9741 @end deffn
9742
9743 @deffn {Command} {etm load} filename
9744 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
9745 @end deffn
9746
9747 @deffn {Command} {etm start}
9748 Starts trace data collection.
9749 @end deffn
9750
9751 @deffn {Command} {etm stop}
9752 Stops trace data collection.
9753 @end deffn
9754
9755 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
9756 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
9757
9758 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
9759
9760 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} {dummy}
9761 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
9762 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
9763 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
9764 any trace data collection.}
9765 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
9766 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
9767 @end deffn
9768 @end deffn
9769
9770 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} {etb}
9771 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
9772 to use on-chip ETB memory.
9773 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
9774 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
9775 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
9776 @end deffn
9777 @deffn {Command} {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
9778 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
9779 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
9780 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
9781 trace trigger becomes active.
9782
9783 @itemize
9784 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
9785 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
9786 afterwards.
9787 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
9788 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
9789 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
9790 what caused that event to happen.
9791 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
9792 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
9793 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
9794 how the event caused trouble.
9795 @end itemize
9796 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
9797 @end deffn
9798
9799 @end deffn
9800
9801 @anchor{armcrosstrigger}
9802 @section ARM Cross-Trigger Interface
9803 @cindex CTI
9804
9805 The ARM Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) is a generic CoreSight component
9806 that connects event sources like tracing components or CPU cores with each
9807 other through a common trigger matrix (CTM). For ARMv8 architecture, a
9808 CTI is mandatory for core run control and each core has an individual
9809 CTI instance attached to it. OpenOCD has limited support for CTI using
9810 the @emph{cti} group of commands.
9811
9812 @deffn {Command} {cti create} cti_name @option{-dap} dap_name @option{-ap-num} apn @option{-baseaddr} base_address
9813 Creates a CTI instance @var{cti_name} on the DAP instance @var{dap_name} on MEM-AP
9814 @var{apn}.
9815 On ADIv5 DAP @var{apn} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the CTI is connected to.
9816 On ADIv6 DAP @var{apn} is the base address of the DAP AP the CTI is connected to.
9817 The @var{base_address} must match the base address of the CTI
9818 on the respective MEM-AP. All arguments are mandatory. This creates a
9819 new command @command{$cti_name} which is used for various purposes
9820 including additional configuration.
9821 @end deffn
9822
9823 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name enable} @option{on|off}
9824 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the CTI.
9825 @end deffn
9826
9827 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name dump}
9828 Displays a register dump of the CTI.
9829 @end deffn
9830
9831 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name write} @var{reg_name} @var{value}
9832 Write @var{value} to the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
9833 @end deffn
9834
9835 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name read} @var{reg_name}
9836 Print the value read from the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
9837 @end deffn
9838
9839 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name ack} @var{event}
9840 Acknowledge a CTI @var{event}.
9841 @end deffn
9842
9843 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name channel} @var{channel_number} @var{operation}
9844 Perform a specific channel operation, the possible operations are:
9845 gate, ungate, set, clear and pulse
9846 @end deffn
9847
9848 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name testmode} @option{on|off}
9849 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the integration test mode
9850 of the CTI.
9851 @end deffn
9852
9853 @deffn {Command} {cti names}
9854 Prints a list of names of all CTI objects created. This command is mainly
9855 useful in TCL scripting.
9856 @end deffn
9857
9858 @section Generic ARM
9859 @cindex ARM
9860
9861 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
9862 They are available in addition to other core-specific
9863 commands that may be available.
9864
9865 @deffn {Command} {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
9866 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
9867 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
9868 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
9869 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
9870 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
9871 @end deffn
9872
9873 @deffn {Command} {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
9874 @cindex disassemble
9875 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
9876 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
9877 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
9878 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
9879 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
9880 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
9881 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
9882
9883 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
9884 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
9885 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
9886 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
9887 with a handful of exceptions.
9888 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
9889 @end deffn
9890
9891 @deffn {Command} {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
9892 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
9893 passing parameters @var{CRn},
9894 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
9895 and using the MCR instruction.
9896 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
9897 an ARM register.)
9898 @end deffn
9899
9900 @deffn {Command} {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
9901 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
9902 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
9903 and the MRC instruction.
9904 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
9905 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
9906 an ARM register.)
9907 @end deffn
9908
9909 @deffn {Command} {arm reg}
9910 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
9911 core mode if necessary.
9912 @end deffn
9913
9914 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9915 @cindex ARM semihosting
9916 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
9917
9918 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
9919 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
9920 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
9921 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
9922 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
9923 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
9924 @end deffn
9925
9926 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_redirect} (@option{disable} | @option{tcp} <port> [@option{debug}|@option{stdio}|@option{all}])
9927 @cindex ARM semihosting
9928 Redirect semihosting messages to a specified TCP port.
9929
9930 This command redirects debug (READC, WRITEC and WRITE0) and stdio (READ, WRITE)
9931 semihosting operations to the specified TCP port.
9932 The command allows to select which type of operations to redirect (debug, stdio, all (default)).
9933
9934 Note: for stdio operations, only I/O from/to ':tt' file descriptors are redirected.
9935 @end deffn
9936
9937 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_cmdline} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9938 @cindex ARM semihosting
9939 Set the command line to be passed to the debugger.
9940
9941 @example
9942 arm semihosting_cmdline argv0 argv1 argv2 ...
9943 @end example
9944
9945 This option lets one set the command line arguments to be passed to
9946 the program. The first argument (argv0) is the program name in a
9947 standard C environment (argv[0]). Depending on the program (not much
9948 programs look at argv[0]), argv0 is ignored and can be any string.
9949 @end deffn
9950
9951 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9952 @cindex ARM semihosting
9953 Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
9954 status.
9955
9956 Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
9957 File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
9958 interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
9959 debugger.
9960 @end deffn
9961
9962 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_resexit} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9963 @cindex ARM semihosting
9964 Enable resumable SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT.
9965
9966 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called outside a debug session,
9967 things are simple, the openocd process calls exit() and passes
9968 the value returned by the target.
9969
9970 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called during a debug session,
9971 by default execution returns to the debugger, leaving the
9972 debugger in a HALT state, similar to the state entered when
9973 encountering a break.
9974
9975 In some use cases, it is useful to have SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT
9976 return normally, as any semihosting call, and do not break
9977 to the debugger.
9978 The standard allows this to happen, but the condition
9979 to trigger it is a bit obscure ("by performing an RDI_Execute
9980 request or equivalent").
9981
9982 To make the SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT call return normally, enable
9983 this option (default: disabled).
9984 @end deffn
9985
9986 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_read_user_param}
9987 @cindex ARM semihosting
9988 Read parameter of the semihosting call from the target. Usable in
9989 semihosting-user-cmd-0x10* event handlers, returning a string.
9990
9991 When the target makes semihosting call with operation number from range 0x100-
9992 0x107, an optional string parameter can be passed to the server. This parameter
9993 is valid during the run of the event handlers and is accessible with this
9994 command.
9995 @end deffn
9996
9997 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_basedir} [dir]
9998 @cindex ARM semihosting
9999 Set the base directory for semihosting I/O, either an absolute path or a path relative to OpenOCD working directory.
10000 Use "." for the current directory.
10001 @end deffn
10002
10003 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
10004 @cindex ARMv4
10005 @cindex ARMv5
10006
10007 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
10008 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
10009 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
10010 variant.
10011
10012 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
10013 @cindex ARM7
10014 @cindex ARM9
10015
10016 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
10017 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
10018 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
10019 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
10020
10021 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
10022 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
10023 EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
10024 instead of breakpoints.
10025 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
10026
10027 This should be
10028 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
10029 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
10030 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
10031 @end deffn
10032
10033 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
10034 @cindex DCC
10035 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
10036 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
10037 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
10038
10039 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
10040 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
10041 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
10042 @end deffn
10043
10044 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
10045 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
10046 that don't check completion of the operation.
10047 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
10048
10049 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
10050 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
10051 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
10052 @end deffn
10053
10054 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
10055 @cindex ARM9
10056
10057 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
10058 integer processors.
10059 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
10060
10061 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
10062 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
10063 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
10064 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
10065
10066 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
10067 @deffn {Command} {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
10068 @cindex vector_catch
10069 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
10070 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
10071 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
10072 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
10073 to those hardware vectors.
10074
10075 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
10076 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
10077 vector catch hardware to intercept
10078 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
10079 @option{none} of them,
10080 or a list with one or more of the following:
10081 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
10082 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
10083 @end deffn
10084
10085 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
10086 @cindex ARM920T
10087
10088 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
10089 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
10090 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
10091 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
10092 and ARM9 commands.
10093
10094 @deffn {Command} {arm920t cache_info}
10095 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
10096 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
10097 @end deffn
10098
10099 @deffn {Command} {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
10100 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
10101 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
10102 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
10103 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
10104 (Not all registers can be written.)
10105 @end deffn
10106
10107 @deffn {Command} {arm920t read_cache} filename
10108 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
10109 @end deffn
10110
10111 @deffn {Command} {arm920t read_mmu} filename
10112 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
10113 @end deffn
10114
10115 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
10116 @cindex ARM926ej-s
10117
10118 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
10119 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
10120 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
10121 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
10122 and ARM9 commands.
10123
10124 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
10125 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
10126
10127 @deffn {Command} {arm926ejs cache_info}
10128 Print information about the caches found.
10129 @end deffn
10130
10131 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
10132 @cindex ARM966E
10133
10134 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
10135 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
10136 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
10137 and ARM9 commands.
10138
10139 @deffn {Command} {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
10140 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
10141 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
10142 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
10143 ARM966E-S TRM.
10144 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
10145 as required for BIST support.
10146 @end deffn
10147
10148 @subsection XScale specific commands
10149 @cindex XScale
10150
10151 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
10152
10153 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
10154 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
10155 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
10156 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
10157 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
10158 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
10159 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
10160
10161 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
10162 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicitly write
10163 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
10164 the mini-IC.
10165
10166 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
10167 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
10168 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
10169 code layout in memory:
10170 @example
10171 _vectors:
10172 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
10173 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
10174 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
10175 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
10176 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
10177 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
10178 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
10179 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
10180 .org 0x100
10181 .long real_reset_vector
10182 .long real_ui_handler
10183 .long real_swi_handler
10184 .long real_pf_abort
10185 .long real_data_abort
10186 .long 0 /* unused */
10187 .long real_irq_handler
10188 .long real_fiq_handler
10189 @end example
10190
10191 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
10192 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
10193 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
10194 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
10195 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
10196 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
10197 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
10198 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
10199 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
10200 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
10201 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
10202 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
10203 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
10204 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
10205 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
10206 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
10207 software.
10208
10209 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
10210 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
10211 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
10212 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
10213
10214 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
10215 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
10216 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
10217 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
10218 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
10219 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
10220 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
10221 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
10222 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
10223
10224 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
10225 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
10226
10227 @deffn {Command} {xscale analyze_trace}
10228 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
10229 @end deffn
10230
10231 @deffn {Command} {xscale cache_clean_address} address
10232 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
10233 @end deffn
10234
10235 @deffn {Command} {xscale cache_info}
10236 Displays information about the CPU caches.
10237 @end deffn
10238
10239 @deffn {Command} {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
10240 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
10241 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
10242 @end deffn
10243
10244 @deffn {Command} {xscale debug_handler} target address
10245 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
10246 @end deffn
10247
10248 @deffn {Command} {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
10249 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
10250 @end deffn
10251
10252 @deffn {Command} {xscale dump_trace} filename
10253 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
10254 @end deffn
10255
10256 @deffn {Command} {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
10257 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
10258 @end deffn
10259
10260 @deffn {Command} {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
10261 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
10262 @end deffn
10263
10264 @deffn {Command} {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
10265 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
10266 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
10267 and modifying how it is emptied.
10268 @end deffn
10269
10270 @deffn {Command} {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
10271 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
10272 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
10273 The image @var{type} may be one of
10274 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
10275 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
10276 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
10277 @end deffn
10278
10279 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
10280 @deffn {Command} {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
10281 @cindex vector_catch
10282 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
10283 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
10284
10285 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
10286 @example
10287 0x01 Trap Reset
10288 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
10289 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
10290 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
10291 0x10 Trap Data Abort
10292 0x20 reserved
10293 0x40 Trap IRQ
10294 0x80 Trap FIQ
10295 @end example
10296 @end deffn
10297
10298 @deffn {Command} {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
10299 @cindex vector_table
10300
10301 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
10302 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
10303 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
10304 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
10305 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
10306
10307 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
10308
10309 @end deffn
10310
10311 @section ARMv6 Architecture
10312 @cindex ARMv6
10313
10314 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
10315 @cindex ARM11
10316
10317 @deffn {Command} {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
10318 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
10319 which is enabled by default.
10320 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
10321 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
10322 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
10323 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
10324 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
10325 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
10326 @end deffn
10327
10328 @deffn {Command} {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
10329 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
10330 which is enabled by default.
10331 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
10332 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
10333 @end deffn
10334
10335 @deffn {Command} {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
10336 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
10337 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
10338 they are disabled by default.
10339 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
10340 @end deffn
10341
10342 @deffn {Command} {arm11 vcr} [value]
10343 @cindex vector_catch
10344 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
10345 coprocessor 14 register 7.
10346 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
10347
10348 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
10349 for certain hardware events.
10350 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
10351 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
10352 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
10353 @end deffn
10354
10355 @section ARMv7 and ARMv8 Architecture
10356 @cindex ARMv7
10357 @cindex ARMv8
10358
10359 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
10360 @cindex Cortex-A
10361
10362 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a cache_info}
10363 display information about target caches
10364 @end deffn
10365
10366 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a dacrfixup} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
10367 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
10368 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
10369 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
10370 Defaults to 'off'.
10371 @end deffn
10372
10373 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a dbginit}
10374 Initialize core debug
10375 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
10376 @end deffn
10377
10378 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a smp} [on|off]
10379 Display/set the current SMP mode
10380 @end deffn
10381
10382 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
10383 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
10384 @end deffn
10385
10386 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
10387 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
10388 @end deffn
10389
10390 @deffn {Command} {cache_config l2x} [base way]
10391 configure l2x cache
10392 @end deffn
10393
10394 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a mmu dump} [@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{addr} address [@option{num_entries}]]
10395 Dump the MMU translation table from TTB0 or TTB1 register, or from physical
10396 memory location @var{address}. When dumping the table from @var{address}, print at most
10397 @var{num_entries} page table entries. @var{num_entries} is optional, if omitted, the maximum
10398 possible (4096) entries are printed.
10399 @end deffn
10400
10401 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
10402 @cindex Cortex-R
10403
10404 @deffn {Command} {cortex_r4 dbginit}
10405 Initialize core debug
10406 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
10407 @end deffn
10408
10409 @deffn {Command} {cortex_r4 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
10410 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
10411 @end deffn
10412
10413
10414 @subsection ARM CoreSight TPIU and SWO specific commands
10415 @cindex tracing
10416 @cindex SWO
10417 @cindex SWV
10418 @cindex TPIU
10419
10420 ARM CoreSight provides several modules to generate debugging
10421 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
10422 through TPIU or SWO modules to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
10423 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
10424
10425 ARM CoreSight provides independent HW blocks named TPIU and SWO each with its
10426 own functionality. Embedded in Cortex-M3 and M4, ARM provides an optional HW
10427 block that includes both TPIU and SWO functionalities and is again named TPIU,
10428 which causes quite some confusion.
10429 The registers map of all the TPIU and SWO implementations allows using a single
10430 driver that detects at runtime the features available.
10431
10432 The @command{tpiu} is used for either TPIU or SWO.
10433 A convenient alias @command{swo} is available to help distinguish, in scripts,
10434 the commands for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
10435
10436 @deffn {Command} {swo} ...
10437 Alias of @command{tpiu ...}. Can be used in scripts to distinguish the commands
10438 for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
10439 @end deffn
10440
10441 @deffn {Command} {tpiu create} tpiu_name configparams...
10442 Creates a TPIU or a SWO object. The two commands are equivalent.
10443 Add the object in a list and add new commands (@command{@var{tpiu_name}})
10444 which are used for various purposes including additional configuration.
10445
10446 @itemize @bullet
10447 @item @var{tpiu_name} -- the name of the TPIU or SWO object.
10448 This name is also used to create the object's command, referred to here
10449 as @command{$tpiu_name}, and in other places where the TPIU or SWO needs to be identified.
10450 @item @var{configparams} -- all parameters accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} are permitted.
10451
10452 You @emph{must} set here the AP and MEM_AP base_address through @code{-dap @var{dap_name}},
10453 @code{-ap-num @var{ap_number}} and @code{-baseaddr @var{base_address}}.
10454 @end itemize
10455 @end deffn
10456
10457 @deffn {Command} {tpiu names}
10458 Lists all the TPIU or SWO objects created so far. The two commands are equivalent.
10459 @end deffn
10460
10461 @deffn {Command} {tpiu init}
10462 Initialize all registered TPIU and SWO. The two commands are equivalent.
10463 These commands are used internally during initialization. They can be issued
10464 at any time after the initialization, too.
10465 @end deffn
10466
10467 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name cget} queryparm
10468 Each configuration parameter accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} can be
10469 individually queried, to return its current value.
10470 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name accepted by that command, such as @code{-dap}.
10471 @end deffn
10472
10473 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name configure} configparams...
10474 The options accepted by this command may also be specified as parameters
10475 to @command{tpiu create}. Their values can later be queried one at a time by
10476 using the @command{$tpiu_name cget} command.
10477
10478 @itemize @bullet
10479 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access this
10480 TPIU. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to create and manage DAP instances.
10481
10482 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- sets DAP access port for TPIU.
10483 On ADIv5 DAP @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the TPIU is connected to.
10484 On ADIv6 DAP @var{ap_number} is the base address of the DAP AP the TPIU is connected to.
10485
10486 @item @code{-baseaddr} @var{base_address} -- sets the TPIU @var{base_address} where
10487 to access the TPIU in the DAP AP memory space.
10488
10489 @item @code{-protocol} (@option{sync}|@option{uart}|@option{manchester}) -- sets the
10490 protocol used for trace data:
10491 @itemize @minus
10492 @item @option{sync} -- synchronous parallel trace output mode, using @var{port_width}
10493 data bits (default);
10494 @item @option{uart} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as regular UART 8N1) coding;
10495 @item @option{manchester} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester coding.
10496 @end itemize
10497
10498 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} -- assigns an event handler,
10499 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered. The events
10500 @code{pre-enable}, @code{post-enable}, @code{pre-disable} and @code{post-disable}
10501 are defined for TPIU/SWO.
10502 A typical use case for the event @code{pre-enable} is to enable the trace clock
10503 of the TPIU.
10504
10505 @item @code{-output} (@option{external}|@option{:}@var{port}|@var{filename}|@option{-}) -- specifies
10506 the destination of the trace data:
10507 @itemize @minus
10508 @item @option{external} -- configure TPIU/SWO to let user capture trace
10509 output externally, either with an additional UART or with a logic analyzer (default);
10510 @item @option{-} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather trace data
10511 and forward it to @command{tcl_trace} command;
10512 @item @option{:}@var{port} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather
10513 trace data, open a TCP server at port @var{port} and send the trace data to
10514 each connected client;
10515 @item @var{filename} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to
10516 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename}, which can be
10517 either a regular file or a named pipe.
10518 @end itemize
10519
10520 @item @code{-traceclk} @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} -- mandatory parameter.
10521 Specifies the frequency in Hz of the trace clock. For the TPIU embedded in
10522 Cortex-M3 or M4, this is usually the same frequency as HCLK. For protocol
10523 @option{sync} this is twice the frequency of the pin data rate.
10524
10525 @item @code{-pin-freq} @var{trace_freq} -- specifies the expected data rate
10526 in Hz of the SWO pin. Parameter used only on protocols @option{uart} and
10527 @option{manchester}. Can be omitted to let the adapter driver select the
10528 maximum supported rate automatically.
10529
10530 @item @code{-port-width} @var{port_width} -- sets to @var{port_width} the width
10531 of the synchronous parallel port used for trace output. Parameter used only on
10532 protocol @option{sync}. If not specified, default value is @var{1}.
10533
10534 @item @code{-formatter} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- specifies if the formatter
10535 should be enabled. Parameter used only on protocol @option{sync}. If not specified,
10536 default value is @var{0}.
10537 @end itemize
10538 @end deffn
10539
10540 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name enable}
10541 Uses the parameters specified by the previous @command{$tpiu_name configure}
10542 to configure and enable the TPIU or the SWO.
10543 If required, the adapter is also configured and enabled to receive the trace
10544 data.
10545 This command can be used before @command{init}, but it will take effect only
10546 after the @command{init}.
10547 @end deffn
10548
10549 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name disable}
10550 Disable the TPIU or the SWO, terminating the receiving of the trace data.
10551 @end deffn
10552
10553
10554
10555 Example usage:
10556 @enumerate
10557 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
10558 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
10559 enough to:
10560 @example
10561 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
10562 ...
10563 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
10564 ...
10565 @end example
10566 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
10567 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
10568 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
10569 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
10570 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
10571 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
10572 @example
10573 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
10574 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
10575 @end example
10576 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
10577 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
10578 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
10579 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
10580 @example
10581 openocd -f interface/stlink.cfg \
10582 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
10583 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
10584 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -protocol uart" \
10585 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -traceclk 24000000 -pin-freq 12000000" \
10586 -c "stm32l1.tpiu enable"
10587 @end example
10588 @end enumerate
10589
10590 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
10591 @cindex tracing
10592 @cindex SWO
10593 @cindex SWV
10594 @cindex ITM
10595 @cindex ETM
10596
10597 @deffn {Command} {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
10598 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
10599 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
10600 @end deffn
10601
10602 @deffn {Command} {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
10603 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
10604 @end deffn
10605
10606 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
10607 @cindex Cortex-M
10608
10609 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off}|@option{steponly})
10610 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
10611
10612 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping in a way that they
10613 get served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
10614 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
10615 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
10616 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
10617 the step command leaves with the core running.
10618
10619 The @option{steponly} option disables interrupts during single-stepping but
10620 enables them during normal execution. This can be used as a partial workaround
10621 for 702596 erratum in Cortex-M7 r0p1. See "Cortex-M7 (AT610) and Cortex-M7 with
10622 FPU (AT611) Software Developer Errata Notice" from ARM for further details.
10623
10624 Note that a free hardware (FPB) breakpoint is required for the @option{auto}
10625 option. If no breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step
10626 is taken with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option
10627 does.
10628
10629 Default is @option{auto}.
10630 @end deffn
10631
10632 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
10633 @cindex vector_catch
10634 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
10635 for certain hardware events.
10636
10637 Parameters request interception of
10638 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
10639 @option{none} of them,
10640 or one or more of the following:
10641 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
10642 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
10643 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
10644 @option{irq_err},
10645 @option{state_err},
10646 @option{chk_err}, or
10647 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
10648 @option{reset}.
10649 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
10650 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
10651 are mapped to HardFault.
10652 UsageFault checks for
10653 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
10654 must also be explicitly enabled.
10655
10656 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
10657 @end deffn
10658
10659 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
10660 Control reset handling if hardware srst is not fitted
10661 @xref{reset_config,,reset_config}.
10662
10663 @itemize @minus
10664 @item @option{sysresetreq} use AIRCR SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
10665 @item @option{vectreset} use AIRCR VECTRESET to reset system (default).
10666 @end itemize
10667
10668 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for Cortex-M3, M4 and M7 cores.
10669 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
10670 are unaffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler
10671 to manually reset the peripherals.
10672 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
10673
10674 Cortex-M0, M0+ and M1 do not support @option{vectreset}, use @option{sysresetreq}
10675 instead.
10676 @end deffn
10677
10678 @subsection ARMv8-A specific commands
10679 @cindex ARMv8-A
10680 @cindex aarch64
10681
10682 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 cache_info}
10683 Display information about target caches
10684 @end deffn
10685
10686 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 dbginit}
10687 This command enables debugging by clearing the OS Lock and sticky power-down and reset
10688 indications. It also establishes the expected, basic cross-trigger configuration the aarch64
10689 target code relies on. In a configuration file, the command would typically be called from a
10690 @code{reset-end} or @code{reset-deassert-post} handler, to re-enable debugging after a system reset.
10691 However, normally it is not necessary to use the command at all.
10692 @end deffn
10693
10694 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 disassemble} address [count]
10695 @cindex disassemble
10696 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
10697 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
10698 @end deffn
10699
10700 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 smp} [on|off]
10701 Display, enable or disable SMP handling mode. The state of SMP handling influences the way targets in an SMP group
10702 are handled by the run control. With SMP handling enabled, issuing halt or resume to one core will trigger
10703 halting or resuming of all cores in the group. The command @code{target smp} defines which targets are in the SMP
10704 group. With SMP handling disabled, all targets need to be treated individually.
10705 @end deffn
10706
10707 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
10708 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping. The default configuration is
10709 @option{on}.
10710 @end deffn
10711
10712 @deffn {Command} {$target_name catch_exc} [@option{off}|@option{sec_el1}|@option{sec_el3}|@option{nsec_el1}|@option{nsec_el2}]+
10713 Cause @command{$target_name} to halt when an exception is taken. Any combination of
10714 Secure (sec) EL1/EL3 or Non-Secure (nsec) EL1/EL2 is valid. The target
10715 @command{$target_name} will halt before taking the exception. In order to resume
10716 the target, the exception catch must be disabled again with @command{$target_name catch_exc off}.
10717 Issuing the command without options prints the current configuration.
10718 @end deffn
10719
10720 @deffn {Command} {$target_name pauth} [@option{off}|@option{on}]
10721 Enable or disable pointer authentication features.
10722 When pointer authentication is used on ARM cores, GDB asks GDB servers for an 8-bytes mask to remove signature bits added by pointer authentication.
10723 If this feature is enabled, OpenOCD provides GDB with an 8-bytes mask.
10724 Pointer authentication feature is broken until gdb 12.1, going to be fixed.
10725 Consider using a newer version of gdb if you want to enable pauth feature.
10726 The default configuration is @option{off}.
10727 @end deffn
10728
10729
10730 @section EnSilica eSi-RISC Architecture
10731
10732 eSi-RISC is a highly configurable microprocessor architecture for embedded systems
10733 provided by EnSilica. (See: @url{http://www.ensilica.com/risc-ip/}.)
10734
10735 @subsection eSi-RISC Configuration
10736
10737 @deffn {Command} {esirisc cache_arch} (@option{harvard}|@option{von_neumann})
10738 Configure the caching architecture. Targets with the @code{UNIFIED_ADDRESS_SPACE}
10739 option disabled employ a Harvard architecture. By default, @option{von_neumann} is assumed.
10740 @end deffn
10741
10742 @deffn {Command} {esirisc hwdc} (@option{all}|@option{none}|mask ...)
10743 Configure hardware debug control. The HWDC register controls which exceptions return
10744 control back to the debugger. Possible masks are @option{all}, @option{none},
10745 @option{reset}, @option{interrupt}, @option{syscall}, @option{error}, and @option{debug}.
10746 By default, @option{reset}, @option{error}, and @option{debug} are enabled.
10747 @end deffn
10748
10749 @subsection eSi-RISC Operation
10750
10751 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flush_caches}
10752 Flush instruction and data caches. This command requires that the target is halted
10753 when the command is issued and configured with an instruction or data cache.
10754 @end deffn
10755
10756 @subsection eSi-Trace Configuration
10757
10758 eSi-RISC targets may be configured with support for instruction tracing. Trace
10759 data may be written to an in-memory buffer or FIFO. If a FIFO is configured, DMA
10760 is typically employed to move trace data off-device using a high-speed
10761 peripheral (eg. SPI). Collected trace data is encoded in one of three different
10762 formats. At a minimum, @command{esirisc trace buffer} or @command{esirisc trace
10763 fifo} must be issued along with @command{esirisc trace format} before trace data
10764 can be collected.
10765
10766 OpenOCD provides rudimentary analysis of collected trace data. If more detail is
10767 needed, collected trace data can be dumped to a file and processed by external
10768 tooling.
10769
10770 @quotation Issues
10771 OpenOCD is unable to process trace data sent to a FIFO. A potential workaround
10772 for this issue is to configure DMA to copy trace data to an in-memory buffer,
10773 which can then be passed to the @command{esirisc trace analyze} and
10774 @command{esirisc trace dump} commands.
10775
10776 It is possible to corrupt trace data when using a FIFO if the peripheral
10777 responsible for draining data from the FIFO is not fast enough. This can be
10778 managed by enabling flow control, however this can impact timing-sensitive
10779 software operation on the CPU.
10780 @end quotation
10781
10782 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace buffer} address size [@option{wrap}]
10783 Configure trace buffer using the provided address and size. If the @option{wrap}
10784 option is specified, trace collection will continue once the end of the buffer
10785 is reached. By default, wrap is disabled.
10786 @end deffn
10787
10788 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace fifo} address
10789 Configure trace FIFO using the provided address.
10790 @end deffn
10791
10792 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace flow_control} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10793 Enable or disable stalling the CPU to collect trace data. By default, flow
10794 control is disabled.
10795 @end deffn
10796
10797 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace format} (@option{full}|@option{branch}|@option{icache}) pc_bits
10798 Configure trace format and number of PC bits to be captured. @option{pc_bits}
10799 must be within 1 and 31 as the LSB is not collected. If external tooling is used
10800 to analyze collected trace data, these values must match.
10801
10802 Supported trace formats:
10803 @itemize
10804 @item @option{full} capture full trace data, allowing execution history and
10805 timing to be determined.
10806 @item @option{branch} capture taken branch instructions and branch target
10807 addresses.
10808 @item @option{icache} capture instruction cache misses.
10809 @end itemize
10810 @end deffn
10811
10812 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger start} (@option{condition}) [start_data start_mask]
10813 Configure trigger start condition using the provided start data and mask. A
10814 brief description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how
10815 these values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
10816
10817 Supported conditions:
10818 @itemize
10819 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace start}).
10820 @item @option{pc} start tracing if the PC matches start data and mask.
10821 @item @option{load} start tracing if the effective address of a load
10822 instruction matches start data and mask.
10823 @item @option{store} start tracing if the effective address of a store
10824 instruction matches start data and mask.
10825 @item @option{exception} start tracing if the EID of an exception matches start
10826 data and mask.
10827 @item @option{eret} start tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
10828 @item @option{wait} start tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
10829 @item @option{stop} start tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
10830 @item @option{high} start tracing when an external signal is a logical high.
10831 @item @option{low} start tracing when an external signal is a logical low.
10832 @end itemize
10833 @end deffn
10834
10835 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger stop} (@option{condition}) [stop_data stop_mask]
10836 Configure trigger stop condition using the provided stop data and mask. A brief
10837 description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how these
10838 values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
10839
10840 Supported conditions:
10841 @itemize
10842 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace stop}).
10843 @item @option{pc} stop tracing if the PC matches stop data and mask.
10844 @item @option{load} stop tracing if the effective address of a load
10845 instruction matches stop data and mask.
10846 @item @option{store} stop tracing if the effective address of a store
10847 instruction matches stop data and mask.
10848 @item @option{exception} stop tracing if the EID of an exception matches stop
10849 data and mask.
10850 @item @option{eret} stop tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
10851 @item @option{wait} stop tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
10852 @item @option{stop} stop tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
10853 @end itemize
10854 @end deffn
10855
10856 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger delay} (@option{trigger}) [cycles]
10857 Configure trigger start/stop delay in clock cycles.
10858
10859 Supported triggers:
10860 @itemize
10861 @item @option{none} no delay to start or stop collection.
10862 @item @option{start} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to start collection.
10863 @item @option{stop} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to stop collection.
10864 @item @option{both} delay @option{cycles} after both triggers to start or stop
10865 collection.
10866 @end itemize
10867 @end deffn
10868
10869 @subsection eSi-Trace Operation
10870
10871 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace init}
10872 Initialize trace collection. This command must be called any time the
10873 configuration changes. If a trace buffer has been configured, the contents will
10874 be overwritten when trace collection starts.
10875 @end deffn
10876
10877 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace info}
10878 Display trace configuration.
10879 @end deffn
10880
10881 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace status}
10882 Display trace collection status.
10883 @end deffn
10884
10885 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace start}
10886 Start manual trace collection.
10887 @end deffn
10888
10889 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace stop}
10890 Stop manual trace collection.
10891 @end deffn
10892
10893 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace analyze} [address size]
10894 Analyze collected trace data. This command may only be used if a trace buffer
10895 has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must be
10896 copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
10897 @option{size} options using DMA.
10898 @end deffn
10899
10900 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace dump} [address size] @file{filename}
10901 Dump collected trace data to file. This command may only be used if a trace
10902 buffer has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must
10903 be copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
10904 @option{size} options using DMA.
10905 @end deffn
10906
10907 @section Intel Architecture
10908
10909 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
10910 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
10911 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
10912 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
10913 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
10914 @itemize
10915 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
10916 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
10917 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
10918 @end itemize
10919
10920 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
10921 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
10922 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
10923
10924 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idw} address
10925 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10926 @end deffn
10927
10928 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idh} address
10929 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10930 @end deffn
10931
10932 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idb} address
10933 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10934 @end deffn
10935
10936 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iww} address
10937 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10938 @end deffn
10939
10940 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iwh} address
10941 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10942 @end deffn
10943
10944 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iwb} address
10945 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10946 @end deffn
10947
10948 @section OpenRISC Architecture
10949
10950 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
10951 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
10952
10953 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
10954 @deffn {Command} {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
10955 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
10956 @end deffn
10957 @deffn {Command} {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
10958 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
10959
10960 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
10961
10962 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
10963 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
10964 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
10965 @end deffn
10966
10967 @subsection Registers commands
10968 @deffn {Command} {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
10969 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
10970 included in the generated target descriptor file.
10971
10972 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
10973
10974 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
10975 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
10976 and "timer" groups.
10977
10978 @emph{example:}
10979 @example
10980 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
10981 @end example
10982
10983 @end deffn
10984
10985 @section RISC-V Architecture
10986
10987 @uref{http://riscv.org/, RISC-V} is a free and open ISA. OpenOCD supports JTAG
10988 debug of RV32 and RV64 cores in heterogeneous multicore systems of up to 32
10989 harts. (It's possible to increase this limit to 1024 by changing
10990 RISCV_MAX_HARTS in riscv.h.) OpenOCD primarily supports 0.13 of the RISC-V
10991 Debug Specification, but there is also support for legacy targets that
10992 implement version 0.11.
10993
10994 @subsection RISC-V Terminology
10995
10996 A @emph{hart} is a hardware thread. A hart may share resources (eg. FPU) with
10997 another hart, or may be a separate core. RISC-V treats those the same, and
10998 OpenOCD exposes each hart as a separate core.
10999
11000 @subsection Vector Registers
11001
11002 For harts that implement the vector extension, OpenOCD provides access to the
11003 relevant CSRs, as well as the vector registers (v0-v31). The size of each
11004 vector register is dependent on the value of vlenb. RISC-V allows each vector
11005 register to be divided into selected-width elements, and this division can be
11006 changed at run-time. Because OpenOCD cannot update register definitions at
11007 run-time, it exposes each vector register to gdb as a union of fields of
11008 vectors so that users can easily access individual bytes, shorts, words,
11009 longs, and quads inside each vector register. It is left to gdb or
11010 higher-level debuggers to present this data in a more intuitive format.
11011
11012 In the XML register description, the vector registers (when vlenb=16) look as
11013 follows:
11014
11015 @example
11016 <feature name="org.gnu.gdb.riscv.vector">
11017 <vector id="bytes" type="uint8" count="16"/>
11018 <vector id="shorts" type="uint16" count="8"/>
11019 <vector id="words" type="uint32" count="4"/>
11020 <vector id="longs" type="uint64" count="2"/>
11021 <vector id="quads" type="uint128" count="1"/>
11022 <union id="riscv_vector">
11023 <field name="b" type="bytes"/>
11024 <field name="s" type="shorts"/>
11025 <field name="w" type="words"/>
11026 <field name="l" type="longs"/>
11027 <field name="q" type="quads"/>
11028 </union>
11029 <reg name="v0" bitsize="128" regnum="4162" save-restore="no"
11030 type="riscv_vector" group="vector"/>
11031 ...
11032 <reg name="v31" bitsize="128" regnum="4193" save-restore="no"
11033 type="riscv_vector" group="vector"/>
11034 </feature>
11035 @end example
11036
11037 @subsection RISC-V Debug Configuration Commands
11038
11039 @deffn {Config Command} {riscv expose_csrs} n[-m|=name] [...]
11040 Configure which CSRs to expose in addition to the standard ones. The CSRs to expose
11041 can be specified as individual register numbers or register ranges (inclusive). For the
11042 individually listed CSRs, a human-readable name can optionally be set using the @code{n=name}
11043 syntax, which will get @code{csr_} prepended to it. If no name is provided, the register will be
11044 named @code{csr<n>}.
11045
11046 By default OpenOCD attempts to expose only CSRs that are mentioned in a spec,
11047 and then only if the corresponding extension appears to be implemented. This
11048 command can be used if OpenOCD gets this wrong, or if the target implements custom
11049 CSRs.
11050
11051 @example
11052 # Expose a single RISC-V CSR number 128 under the name "csr128":
11053 $_TARGETNAME expose_csrs 128
11054
11055 # Expose multiple RISC-V CSRs 128..132 under names "csr128" through "csr132":
11056 $_TARGETNAME expose_csrs 128-132
11057
11058 # Expose a single RISC-V CSR number 1996 under custom name "csr_myregister":
11059 $_TARGETNAME expose_csrs 1996=myregister
11060 @end example
11061 @end deffn
11062
11063 @deffn {Config Command} {riscv expose_custom} n[-m|=name] [...]
11064 The RISC-V Debug Specification allows targets to expose custom registers
11065 through abstract commands. (See Section 3.5.1.1 in that document.) This command
11066 configures individual registers or register ranges (inclusive) that shall be exposed.
11067 Number 0 indicates the first custom register, whose abstract command number is 0xc000.
11068 For individually listed registers, a human-readable name can be optionally provided
11069 using the @code{n=name} syntax, which will get @code{custom_} prepended to it. If no
11070 name is provided, the register will be named @code{custom<n>}.
11071
11072 @example
11073 # Expose one RISC-V custom register with number 0xc010 (0xc000 + 16)
11074 # under the name "custom16":
11075 $_TARGETNAME expose_custom 16
11076
11077 # Expose a range of RISC-V custom registers with numbers 0xc010 .. 0xc018
11078 # (0xc000+16 .. 0xc000+24) under the names "custom16" through "custom24":
11079 $_TARGETNAME expose_custom 16-24
11080
11081 # Expose one RISC-V custom register with number 0xc020 (0xc000 + 32) under
11082 # user-defined name "custom_myregister":
11083 $_TARGETNAME expose_custom 32=myregister
11084 @end example
11085 @end deffn
11086
11087 @deffn {Command} {riscv info}
11088 Displays some information OpenOCD detected about the target.
11089 @end deffn
11090
11091 @deffn {Command} {riscv reset_delays} [wait]
11092 OpenOCD learns how many Run-Test/Idle cycles are required between scans to avoid
11093 encountering the target being busy. This command resets those learned values
11094 after `wait` scans. It's only useful for testing OpenOCD itself.
11095 @end deffn
11096
11097 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_command_timeout_sec} [seconds]
11098 Set the wall-clock timeout (in seconds) for individual commands. The default
11099 should work fine for all but the slowest targets (eg. simulators).
11100 @end deffn
11101
11102 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_reset_timeout_sec} [seconds]
11103 Set the maximum time to wait for a hart to come out of reset after reset is
11104 deasserted.
11105 @end deffn
11106
11107 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_mem_access} method1 [method2] [method3]
11108 Specify which RISC-V memory access method(s) shall be used, and in which order
11109 of priority. At least one method must be specified.
11110
11111 Available methods are:
11112 @itemize
11113 @item @code{progbuf} - Use RISC-V Debug Program Buffer to access memory.
11114 @item @code{sysbus} - Access memory via RISC-V Debug System Bus interface.
11115 @item @code{abstract} - Access memory via RISC-V Debug abstract commands.
11116 @end itemize
11117
11118 By default, all memory access methods are enabled in the following order:
11119 @code{progbuf sysbus abstract}.
11120
11121 This command can be used to change the memory access methods if the default
11122 behavior is not suitable for a particular target.
11123 @end deffn
11124
11125 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_enable_virtual} on|off
11126 When on, memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory depending
11127 on the current system configuration. When off (default), all memory accessses are performed
11128 on physical memory.
11129 @end deffn
11130
11131 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_enable_virt2phys} on|off
11132 When on (default), memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory
11133 depending on the current satp configuration. When off, all memory accessses are
11134 performed on physical memory.
11135 @end deffn
11136
11137 @deffn {Command} {riscv resume_order} normal|reversed
11138 Some software assumes all harts are executing nearly continuously. Such
11139 software may be sensitive to the order that harts are resumed in. On harts
11140 that don't support hasel, this option allows the user to choose the order the
11141 harts are resumed in. If you are using this option, it's probably masking a
11142 race condition problem in your code.
11143
11144 Normal order is from lowest hart index to highest. This is the default
11145 behavior. Reversed order is from highest hart index to lowest.
11146 @end deffn
11147
11148 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ir} (@option{idcode}|@option{dtmcs}|@option{dmi}) [value]
11149 Set the IR value for the specified JTAG register. This is useful, for
11150 example, when using the existing JTAG interface on a Xilinx FPGA by
11151 way of BSCANE2 primitives that only permit a limited selection of IR
11152 values.
11153
11154 When utilizing version 0.11 of the RISC-V Debug Specification,
11155 @option{dtmcs} and @option{dmi} set the IR values for the DTMCONTROL
11156 and DBUS registers, respectively.
11157 @end deffn
11158
11159 @deffn {Command} {riscv use_bscan_tunnel} value
11160 Enable or disable use of a BSCAN tunnel to reach DM. Supply the width of
11161 the DM transport TAP's instruction register to enable. Supply a value of 0 to disable.
11162 @end deffn
11163
11164 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreakm} on|off
11165 Control dcsr.ebreakm. When on (default), M-mode ebreak instructions trap to
11166 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
11167 @end deffn
11168
11169 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreaks} on|off
11170 Control dcsr.ebreaks. When on (default), S-mode ebreak instructions trap to
11171 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
11172 @end deffn
11173
11174 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreaku} on|off
11175 Control dcsr.ebreaku. When on (default), U-mode ebreak instructions trap to
11176 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
11177 @end deffn
11178
11179 @subsection RISC-V Authentication Commands
11180
11181 The following commands can be used to authenticate to a RISC-V system. Eg. a
11182 trivial challenge-response protocol could be implemented as follows in a
11183 configuration file, immediately following @command{init}:
11184 @example
11185 set challenge [riscv authdata_read]
11186 riscv authdata_write [expr @{$challenge + 1@}]
11187 @end example
11188
11189 @deffn {Command} {riscv authdata_read}
11190 Return the 32-bit value read from authdata.
11191 @end deffn
11192
11193 @deffn {Command} {riscv authdata_write} value
11194 Write the 32-bit value to authdata.
11195 @end deffn
11196
11197 @subsection RISC-V DMI Commands
11198
11199 The following commands allow direct access to the Debug Module Interface, which
11200 can be used to interact with custom debug features.
11201
11202 @deffn {Command} {riscv dmi_read} address
11203 Perform a 32-bit DMI read at address, returning the value.
11204 @end deffn
11205
11206 @deffn {Command} {riscv dmi_write} address value
11207 Perform a 32-bit DMI write of value at address.
11208 @end deffn
11209
11210 @section ARC Architecture
11211 @cindex ARC
11212
11213 Synopsys DesignWare ARC Processors are a family of 32-bit CPUs that SoC
11214 designers can optimize for a wide range of uses, from deeply embedded to
11215 high-performance host applications in a variety of market segments. See more
11216 at: @url{http://www.synopsys.com/IP/ProcessorIP/ARCProcessors/Pages/default.aspx}.
11217 OpenOCD currently supports ARC EM processors.
11218 There is a set ARC-specific OpenOCD commands that allow low-level
11219 access to the core and provide necessary support for ARC extensibility and
11220 configurability capabilities. ARC processors has much more configuration
11221 capabilities than most of the other processors and in addition there is an
11222 extension interface that allows SoC designers to add custom registers and
11223 instructions. For the OpenOCD that mostly means that set of core and AUX
11224 registers in target will vary and is not fixed for a particular processor
11225 model. To enable extensibility several TCL commands are provided that allow to
11226 describe those optional registers in OpenOCD configuration files. Moreover
11227 those commands allow for a dynamic target features discovery.
11228
11229
11230 @subsection General ARC commands
11231
11232 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg} configparams
11233
11234 Add a new register to processor target. By default newly created register is
11235 marked as not existing. @var{configparams} must have following required
11236 arguments:
11237
11238 @itemize @bullet
11239
11240 @item @code{-name} name
11241 @*Name of a register.
11242
11243 @item @code{-num} number
11244 @*Architectural register number: core register number or AUX register number.
11245
11246 @item @code{-feature} XML_feature
11247 @*Name of GDB XML target description feature.
11248
11249 @end itemize
11250
11251 @var{configparams} may have following optional arguments:
11252
11253 @itemize @bullet
11254
11255 @item @code{-gdbnum} number
11256 @*GDB register number. It is recommended to not assign GDB register number
11257 manually, because there would be a risk that two register will have same
11258 number. When register GDB number is not set with this option, then register
11259 will get a previous register number + 1. This option is required only for those
11260 registers that must be at particular address expected by GDB.
11261
11262 @item @code{-core}
11263 @*This option specifies that register is a core registers. If not - this is an
11264 AUX register. AUX registers and core registers reside in different address
11265 spaces.
11266
11267 @item @code{-bcr}
11268 @*This options specifies that register is a BCR register. BCR means Build
11269 Configuration Registers - this is a special type of AUX registers that are read
11270 only and non-volatile, that is - they never change their value. Therefore OpenOCD
11271 never invalidates values of those registers in internal caches. Because BCR is a
11272 type of AUX registers, this option cannot be used with @code{-core}.
11273
11274 @item @code{-type} type_name
11275 @*Name of type of this register. This can be either one of the basic GDB types,
11276 or a custom types described with @command{arc add-reg-type-[flags|struct]}.
11277
11278 @item @code{-g}
11279 @* If specified then this is a "general" register. General registers are always
11280 read by OpenOCD on context save (when core has just been halted) and is always
11281 transferred to GDB client in a response to g-packet. Contrary to this,
11282 non-general registers are read and sent to GDB client on-demand. In general it
11283 is not recommended to apply this option to custom registers.
11284
11285 @end itemize
11286
11287 @end deffn
11288
11289 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-flags} -name name flags...
11290 Adds new register type of ``flags'' class. ``Flags'' types can contain only
11291 one-bit fields. Each flag definition looks like @code{-flag name bit-position}.
11292 @end deffn
11293
11294 @anchor{add-reg-type-struct}
11295 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-struct} -name name structs...
11296 Adds new register type of ``struct'' class. ``Struct'' types can contain either
11297 bit-fields or fields of other types, however at the moment only bit fields are
11298 supported. Structure bit field definition looks like @code{-bitfield name
11299 startbit endbit}.
11300 @end deffn
11301
11302 @deffn {Command} {arc get-reg-field} reg-name field-name
11303 Returns value of bit-field in a register. Register must be ``struct'' register
11304 type, @xref{add-reg-type-struct}. command definition.
11305 @end deffn
11306
11307 @deffn {Command} {arc set-reg-exists} reg-names...
11308 Specify that some register exists. Any amount of names can be passed
11309 as an argument for a single command invocation.
11310 @end deffn
11311
11312 @subsection ARC JTAG commands
11313
11314 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-aux-reg} regnum value
11315 This command writes value to AUX register via its number. This command access
11316 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
11317 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
11318
11319 @end deffn
11320
11321 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-core-reg} regnum value
11322 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag set-aux-reg} but is for core
11323 registers.
11324 @end deffn
11325
11326 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-aux-reg} regnum
11327 This command returns the value storded in AUX register via its number. This commands access
11328 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
11329 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
11330
11331 @end deffn
11332
11333 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-core-reg} regnum
11334 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag get-aux-reg} but is for core
11335 registers.
11336 @end deffn
11337
11338 @section STM8 Architecture
11339 @uref{http://st.com/stm8/, STM8} is a 8-bit microcontroller platform from
11340 STMicroelectronics, based on a proprietary 8-bit core architecture.
11341
11342 OpenOCD supports debugging STM8 through the STMicroelectronics debug
11343 protocol SWIM, @pxref{swimtransport,,SWIM}.
11344
11345 @section Xtensa Architecture
11346
11347 Xtensa is a highly-customizable, user-extensible microprocessor and DSP
11348 architecture for complex embedded systems provided by Cadence Design
11349 Systems, Inc. See the
11350 @uref{https://www.cadence.com/en_US/home/tools/ip/tensilica-ip.html, Tensilica IP}
11351 website for additional information and documentation.
11352
11353 OpenOCD supports generic Xtensa processor implementations which can be customized by
11354 providing a core-specific configuration file which describes every enabled
11355 Xtensa architecture option, e.g. number of address registers, exceptions, reduced
11356 size instructions support, memory banks configuration etc. OpenOCD also supports SMP
11357 configurations for Xtensa processors with any number of cores and allows configuring
11358 their debug interconnect (termed "break/stall networks"), which control how debug
11359 signals are distributed among cores. Xtensa "break networks" are compatible with
11360 ARM's Cross Trigger Interface (CTI). OpenOCD implements both generic Xtensa targets
11361 as well as several Espressif Xtensa-based chips from the
11362 @uref{https://www.espressif.com/en/products/socs, ESP32 family}.
11363
11364 OCD sessions for Xtensa processor and DSP targets are accessed via the Xtensa
11365 Debug Module (XDM), which provides external connectivity either through a
11366 traditional JTAG interface or an ARM DAP interface. If used, the DAP interface
11367 can control Xtensa targets through JTAG or SWD probes.
11368
11369 @subsection Xtensa Core Configuration
11370
11371 Due to the high level of configurability in Xtensa cores, the Xtensa target
11372 configuration comprises two categories:
11373
11374 @enumerate
11375 @item Base Xtensa support common to all core configurations, and
11376 @item Core-specific support as configured for individual cores.
11377 @end enumerate
11378
11379 All common Xtensa support is built into the OpenOCD Xtensa target layer and
11380 is enabled through a combination of TCL scripts: the target-specific
11381 @file{target/xtensa.cfg} and a board-specific @file{board/xtensa-*.cfg},
11382 similar to other target architectures.
11383
11384 Importantly, core-specific configuration information must be provided by
11385 the user, and takes the form of an @file{xtensa-core-XXX.cfg} TCL script that
11386 defines the core's configurable features through a series of Xtensa
11387 configuration commands (detailed below).
11388
11389 This core-specific @file{xtensa-core-XXX.cfg} file is typically either:
11390
11391 @itemize @bullet
11392 @item Located within the Xtensa core configuration build as
11393 @file{src/config/xtensa-core-openocd.cfg}, or
11394 @item Generated by running the command @code{xt-gdb --dump-oocd-config}
11395 from the Xtensa processor tool-chain's command-line tools.
11396 @end itemize
11397
11398 NOTE: @file{xtensa-core-XXX.cfg} must match the target Xtensa hardware
11399 connected to OpenOCD.
11400
11401 Some example Xtensa configurations are bundled with OpenOCD for reference:
11402 @enumerate
11403 @item Cadence Palladium VDebug emulation target. The user can combine their
11404 @file{xtensa-core-XXX.cfg} with the provided
11405 @file{board/xtensa-palladium-vdebug.cfg} to debug an emulated Xtensa RTL design.
11406 @item NXP MIMXRT685-EVK evaluation kit. The relevant configuration files are:
11407 @itemize @bullet
11408 @item @file{board/xtensa-rt685-ext.cfg}
11409 @item @file{target/xtensa-core-nxp_rt600.cfg}
11410 @end itemize
11411 Additional information is available by searching for "i.MX RT600 Evaluation Kit"
11412 on @url{https://www.nxp.com}.
11413 @end enumerate
11414
11415 @subsection Xtensa Configuration Commands
11416
11417 @deffn {Config Command} {xtensa xtdef} (@option{LX}|@option{NX})
11418 Configure the Xtensa target architecture. Currently, Xtensa support is limited
11419 to LX6, LX7, and NX cores.
11420 @end deffn
11421
11422 @deffn {Config Command} {xtensa xtopt} option value
11423 Configure Xtensa target options that are relevant to the debug subsystem.
11424 @var{option} is one of: @option{arnum}, @option{windowed},
11425 @option{cpenable}, @option{exceptions}, @option{intnum}, @option{hipriints},
11426 @option{excmlevel}, @option{intlevels}, @option{debuglevel},
11427 @option{ibreaknum}, or @option{dbreaknum}. @var{value} is an integer with
11428 the exact range determined by each particular option.
11429
11430 NOTE: Some options are specific to Xtensa LX or Xtensa NX architecture, while
11431 others may be common to both but have different valid ranges.
11432 @end deffn
11433
11434 @deffn {Config Command} {xtensa xtmem} (@option{iram}|@option{dram}|@option{sram}|@option{irom}|@option{drom}|@option{srom}) baseaddr bytes
11435 Configure Xtensa target memory. Memory type determines access rights,
11436 where RAMs are read/write while ROMs are read-only. @var{baseaddr} and
11437 @var{bytes} are both integers, typically hexadecimal and decimal, respectively.
11438
11439 NOTE: Some Xtensa memory types, such as system RAM/ROM or MMIO/device regions,
11440 can be added or modified after the Xtensa core has been generated. Additional
11441 @code{xtensa xtmem} definitions should be manually added to xtensa-core-XXX.cfg
11442 to keep OpenOCD's target address map consistent with the Xtensa configuration.
11443 @end deffn
11444
11445 @deffn {Config Command} {xtensa xtmem} (@option{icache}|@option{dcache}) linebytes cachebytes ways [writeback]
11446 Configure Xtensa processor cache. All parameters are required except for
11447 the optional @option{writeback} parameter; all are integers.
11448 @end deffn
11449
11450 @deffn {Config Command} {xtensa xtmpu} numfgseg minsegsz lockable execonly
11451 Configure an Xtensa Memory Protection Unit (MPU). MPUs can restrict access
11452 and/or control cacheability of specific address ranges, but are lighter-weight
11453 than a full traditional MMU. All parameters are required; all are integers.
11454 @end deffn
11455
11456 @deffn {Config Command} {xtensa xtmmu} numirefillentries numdrefillentries
11457 (Xtensa-LX only) Configure an Xtensa Memory Management Unit (MMU). Both
11458 parameters are required; both are integers.
11459 @end deffn
11460
11461 @deffn {Config Command} {xtensa xtregs} numregs
11462 Configure the total number of registers for the Xtensa core. Configuration
11463 logic expects to subsequently process this number of @code{xtensa xtreg}
11464 definitions. @var{numregs} is an integer.
11465 @end deffn
11466
11467 @deffn {Config Command} {xtensa xtregfmt} (@option{sparse}|@option{contiguous}) [general]
11468 Configure the type of register map used by GDB to access the Xtensa core.
11469 Generic Xtensa tools (e.g. xt-gdb) require @option{sparse} mapping (default) while
11470 Espressif tools expect @option{contiguous} mapping. Contiguous mapping takes an
11471 additional, optional integer parameter @option{numgregs}, which specifies the number
11472 of general registers used in handling g/G packets.
11473 @end deffn
11474
11475 @deffn {Config Command} {xtensa xtreg} name offset
11476 Configure an Xtensa core register. All core registers are 32 bits wide,
11477 while TIE and user registers may have variable widths. @var{name} is a
11478 character string identifier while @var{offset} is a hexadecimal integer.
11479 @end deffn
11480
11481 @subsection Xtensa Operation Commands
11482
11483 @deffn {Command} {xtensa maskisr} (@option{on}|@option{off})
11484 (Xtensa-LX only) Mask or unmask Xtensa interrupts during instruction step.
11485 When masked, an interrupt that occurs during a step operation is handled and
11486 its ISR is executed, with the user's debug session returning after potentially
11487 executing many instructions. When unmasked, a triggered interrupt will result
11488 in execution progressing the requested number of instructions into the relevant
11489 vector/ISR code.
11490 @end deffn
11491
11492 @deffn {Command} {xtensa set_permissive} (0|1)
11493 By default accessing memory beyond defined regions is forbidden. This commnd controls memory access address check.
11494 When set to (1), skips access controls and address range check before read/write memory.
11495 @end deffn
11496
11497 @deffn {Command} {xtensa smpbreak} [none|breakinout|runstall] | [BreakIn] [BreakOut] [RunStallIn] [DebugModeOut]
11498 Configures debug signals connection ("break network") for currently selected core.
11499 @itemize @bullet
11500 @item @code{none} - Core's "break/stall network" is disconnected. Core is not affected by any debug
11501 signal from other cores.
11502 @item @code{breakinout} - Core's "break network" is fully connected (break inputs and outputs are enabled).
11503 Core will receive debug break signals from other cores and send such signals to them. For example when another core
11504 is stopped due to breakpoint hit this core will be stopped too and vice versa.
11505 @item @code{runstall} - Core's "stall network" is fully connected (stall inputs and outputs are enabled).
11506 This feature is not well implemented and tested yet.
11507 @item @code{BreakIn} - Core's "break-in" signal is enabled.
11508 Core will receive debug break signals from other cores. For example when another core is
11509 stopped due to breakpoint hit this core will be stopped too.
11510 @item @code{BreakOut} - Core's "break-out" signal is enabled.
11511 Core will send debug break signal to other cores. For example when this core is
11512 stopped due to breakpoint hit other cores with enabled break-in signals will be stopped too.
11513 @item @code{RunStallIn} - Core's "runstall-in" signal is enabled.
11514 This feature is not well implemented and tested yet.
11515 @item @code{DebugModeOut} - Core's "debugmode-out" signal is enabled.
11516 This feature is not well implemented and tested yet.
11517 @end itemize
11518 @end deffn
11519
11520 @deffn {Command} {xtensa exe} <ascii-encoded hexadecimal instruction bytes>
11521 Execute arbitrary instruction(s) provided as an ascii string. The string represents an integer
11522 number of instruction bytes, thus its length must be even.
11523 @end deffn
11524
11525 @deffn {Command} {xtensa dm} (address) [value]
11526 Read or write Xtensa Debug Module (DM) registers. @var{address} is required for both reads
11527 and writes and is a 4-byte-aligned value typically between 0 and 0x3ffc. @var{value} is specified
11528 only for write accesses.
11529 @end deffn
11530
11531 @subsection Xtensa Performance Monitor Configuration
11532
11533 @deffn {Command} {xtensa perfmon_enable} <counter_id> <select> [mask] [kernelcnt] [tracelevel]
11534 Enable and start performance counter.
11535 @itemize @bullet
11536 @item @code{counter_id} - Counter ID (0-1).
11537 @item @code{select} - Selects performance metric to be counted by the counter,
11538 e.g. 0 - CPU cycles, 2 - retired instructions.
11539 @item @code{mask} - Selects input subsets to be counted (counter will
11540 increment only once even if more than one condition corresponding to a mask bit occurs).
11541 @item @code{kernelcnt} - 0 - count events with "CINTLEVEL <= tracelevel",
11542 1 - count events with "CINTLEVEL > tracelevel".
11543 @item @code{tracelevel} - Compares this value to "CINTLEVEL" when deciding
11544 whether to count.
11545 @end itemize
11546 @end deffn
11547
11548 @deffn {Command} {xtensa perfmon_dump} (counter_id)
11549 Dump performance counter value. If no argument specified, dumps all counters.
11550 @end deffn
11551
11552 @subsection Xtensa Trace Configuration
11553
11554 @deffn {Command} {xtensa tracestart} [pc <pcval>/[<maskbitcount>]] [after <n> [ins|words]]
11555 Set up and start a HW trace. Optionally set PC address range to trigger tracing stop when reached during program execution.
11556 This command also allows to specify the amount of data to capture after stop trigger activation.
11557 @itemize @bullet
11558 @item @code{pcval} - PC value which will trigger trace data collection stop.
11559 @item @code{maskbitcount} - PC value mask.
11560 @item @code{n} - Maximum number of instructions/words to capture after trace stop trigger.
11561 @end itemize
11562 @end deffn
11563
11564 @deffn {Command} {xtensa tracestop}
11565 Stop current trace as started by the tracestart command.
11566 @end deffn
11567
11568 @deffn {Command} {xtensa tracedump} <outfile>
11569 Dump trace memory to a file.
11570 @end deffn
11571
11572 @section Espressif Specific Commands
11573
11574 @deffn {Command} {esp apptrace} (start <destination> [<poll_period> [<trace_size> [<stop_tmo> [<wait4halt> [<skip_size>]]]]])
11575 Starts
11576 @uref{https://docs.espressif.com/projects/esp-idf/en/latest/esp32/api-guides/app_trace.html#application-level-tracing-library, application level tracing}.
11577 Data will be stored to specified destination. Available destinations are:
11578 @itemize @bullet
11579 @item @code{file://<outfile>} - Save trace logs into file.
11580 @item @code{tcp://<host>:<port>} - Send trace logs to tcp port on specified host. OpenOCD will act as a tcp client.
11581 @item @code{con:} - Print trace logs to the stdout.
11582 @end itemize
11583 Other parameters will be same for each destination.
11584 @itemize @bullet
11585 @item @code{poll_period} - trace data polling period in ms.
11586 @item @code{trace_size} - maximum trace data size.
11587 Tracing will be stopped automatically when that amount is reached.
11588 Use "-1" to disable the limitation.
11589 @item @code{stop_tmo} - Data reception timeout in ms.
11590 Tracing will be stopped automatically when no data is received within that period.
11591 @item @code{wait4halt} - if non-zero then wait for target to be halted before tracing start.
11592 @item @code{skip_size} - amount of tracing data to be skipped before writing it to destination.
11593 @end itemize
11594 @end deffn
11595
11596 @deffn {Command} {esp apptrace} (stop)
11597 Stops tracing started with above command.
11598 @end deffn
11599
11600 @deffn {Command} {esp apptrace} (status)
11601 Requests ongoing tracing status.
11602 @end deffn
11603
11604 @deffn {Command} {esp apptrace} (dump file://<outfile>)
11605 Dumps tracing data from target buffer. It can be useful to dump the latest data
11606 buffered on target for post-mortem analysis. For example when target starts tracing automatically
11607 w/o OpenOCD command and keeps only the latest data window which fit into the buffer.
11608 @uref{https://docs.espressif.com/projects/esp-idf/en/latest/esp32/api-guides/app_trace.html#application-level-tracing-library, application level tracing}.
11609 Data will be stored to specified destination.
11610 @end deffn
11611
11612 @deffn {Command} {esp sysview} (start file://<outfile1> [file://<outfile2>] [<poll_period> [<trace_size> [<stop_tmo> [<wait4halt> [<skip_size>]]]]])
11613 Starts @uref{https://www.segger.com/products/development-tools/systemview/, SEGGER SystemView}
11614 compatible tracing. Data will be stored to specified destination.
11615 For dual-core chips traces from every core will be saved to separate files.
11616 Resulting files can be open in "SEGGER SystemView" application.
11617 @url{https://docs.espressif.com/projects/esp-idf/en/latest/esp32/api-guides/app_trace.html#openocd-systemview-tracing-command-options}
11618 The meaning of the arguments is identical to @command{esp apptrace start}.
11619 @end deffn
11620
11621 @deffn {Command} {esp sysview} (stop)
11622 Stops SystremView compatible tracing started with above command.
11623 @url{https://docs.espressif.com/projects/esp-idf/en/latest/esp32/api-guides/app_trace.html#openocd-systemview-tracing-command-options}
11624 @end deffn
11625
11626 @deffn {Command} {esp sysview} (status)
11627 Requests ongoing SystremView compatible tracing status.
11628 @url{https://docs.espressif.com/projects/esp-idf/en/latest/esp32/api-guides/app_trace.html#openocd-systemview-tracing-command-options}
11629 @end deffn
11630
11631 @deffn {Command} {esp sysview_mcore} (start file://<outfile> [<poll_period> [<trace_size> [<stop_tmo> [<wait4halt> [<skip_size>]]]]])
11632 This command is identical to @command{esp sysview start}, but uses Espressif multi-core extension to
11633 @uref{https://www.segger.com/products/development-tools/systemview/, SEGGER SystemView} data format.
11634 Data will be stored to specified destination. Tracing data from all cores are saved in the same file.
11635 The meaning of the arguments is identical to @command{esp sysview start}.
11636 @end deffn
11637
11638 @deffn {Command} {esp sysview_mcore} (stop)
11639 Stops Espressif multi-core SystremView tracing started with above command.
11640 @end deffn
11641
11642 @deffn {Command} {esp sysview_mcore} (status)
11643 Requests ongoing Espressif multi-core SystremView tracing status.
11644 @end deffn
11645
11646 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
11647 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
11648 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
11649 @cindex tracing
11650 @cindex libdcc
11651 @cindex DCC
11652 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
11653 the target uses appropriate libraries.
11654 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
11655 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
11656
11657 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
11658 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
11659 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
11660 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
11661 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
11662 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
11663
11664 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
11665 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
11666 arrays of various size integers from the target,
11667 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
11668 The target being debugged may
11669 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
11670 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
11671 each supported by a command:
11672
11673 @itemize
11674 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
11675 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
11676 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
11677 finding out how some fault was triggered.
11678
11679 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
11680 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
11681 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
11682
11683 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
11684 and then displayed at any time.
11685 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
11686
11687 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
11688 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
11689 @end itemize
11690
11691 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
11692 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
11693 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
11694 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
11695 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
11696 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
11697 does the same thing.
11698
11699 @deffn {Command} {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
11700 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
11701 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
11702 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
11703 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
11704
11705 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
11706 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
11707 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
11708 @end deffn
11709
11710 @deffn {Command} {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
11711 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
11712 in the order they triggered.
11713 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
11714 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
11715 history records.
11716 @end deffn
11717
11718 @deffn {Command} {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
11719 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
11720 they have been triggered.
11721 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
11722 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
11723 and associates it with that identifier.
11724
11725 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
11726 are not related except by this command.
11727 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
11728 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
11729 @end deffn
11730
11731
11732 @node JTAG Commands
11733 @chapter JTAG Commands
11734 @cindex JTAG Commands
11735 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
11736 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
11737 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
11738 may be needed to work with targets which require special
11739 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
11740
11741 To use these commands you will need to understand some
11742 of the basics of JTAG, including:
11743
11744 @itemize @bullet
11745 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
11746 devices such as a CPUs.
11747 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
11748 standard state machine (in parallel)
11749 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
11750 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
11751 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
11752 while the reading previous ones.
11753 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
11754 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
11755 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
11756 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
11757 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
11758 registers.
11759 @end itemize
11760
11761 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
11762
11763 These commands are used by developers who need to access
11764 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
11765 the order of TAP state transitions.
11766 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
11767 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
11768 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
11769 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
11770 these commands are not available.
11771
11772 @deffn {Command} {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
11773 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
11774 that specify the entire register.
11775 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
11776 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
11777 The return value holds the original value of each
11778 of those fields.
11779
11780 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
11781 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
11782 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
11783 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
11784 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
11785
11786 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
11787 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
11788
11789 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
11790 in that state.
11791 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
11792 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
11793 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
11794
11795 @quotation Warning
11796 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
11797 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
11798 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
11799 data registers, which may have different lengths.
11800 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
11801 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
11802 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
11803 (by connecting a different scan chain).
11804 @end quotation
11805 @end deffn
11806
11807 @deffn {Command} {flush_count}
11808 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
11809 This may be used for performance tuning.
11810
11811 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
11812 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
11813 not change with the amount of data which is written.
11814 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
11815 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
11816 instead of batching them into larger operations.
11817 @end deffn
11818
11819 @deffn {Command} {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
11820 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
11821 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
11822 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
11823 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
11824 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
11825
11826 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
11827 in that state.
11828 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
11829 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
11830 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
11831
11832 @quotation Note
11833 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
11834 register values, unlike data register values.
11835 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
11836 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
11837 @end quotation
11838 @end deffn
11839
11840 @deffn {Command} {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
11841 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
11842 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
11843 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
11844 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
11845 Then, in a series of single state transitions
11846 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
11847 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
11848 The final state must also be stable.
11849 @end deffn
11850
11851 @deffn {Command} {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
11852 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
11853 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
11854 Instructions often need some time
11855 to execute before they take effect.
11856 @end deffn
11857
11858 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
11859 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
11860
11861 @deffn {Command} {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
11862 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
11863 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
11864 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
11865 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
11866 @end deffn
11867
11868 @deffn {Command} {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
11869 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
11870 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
11871 must also be enabled.
11872 Default is enabled.
11873 @end deffn
11874
11875 @section TAP state names
11876 @cindex TAP state names
11877
11878 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
11879 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
11880 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
11881 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
11882
11883 @itemize @bullet
11884 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
11885 acts as if TRST were pulsed
11886 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
11887 @item @b{DRSELECT}
11888 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
11889 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
11890 through the data register
11891 @item @b{DREXIT1}
11892 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
11893 for update or more shifting
11894 @item @b{DREXIT2}
11895 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
11896 @item @b{IRSELECT}
11897 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
11898 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
11899 through the instruction register
11900 @item @b{IREXIT1}
11901 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
11902 for update or more shifting
11903 @item @b{IREXIT2}
11904 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
11905 @end itemize
11906
11907 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
11908 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
11909 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
11910 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
11911
11912 @itemize @bullet
11913 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
11914 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
11915 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
11916 may not be as expected.
11917 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
11918 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
11919 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
11920 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
11921 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
11922 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
11923 @end itemize
11924
11925 @node Boundary Scan Commands
11926 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
11927
11928 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
11929 boundary scan based hardware testing.
11930 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
11931 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
11932
11933 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
11934 @cindex Serial Vector Format
11935 @cindex SVF
11936
11937 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
11938 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
11939 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
11940 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
11941
11942 @deffn {Command} {svf} @file{filename} [@option{-tap @var{tapname}}] [@option{-quiet}] @
11943 [@option{-nil}] [@option{-progress}] [@option{-ignore_error}] @
11944 [@option{-noreset}] [@option{-addcycles @var{cyclecount}}]
11945 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
11946 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
11947
11948 Arguments can be specified in any order; the optional dash doesn't
11949 affect their semantics.
11950
11951 Command options:
11952 @itemize @minus
11953 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} ignore IR and DR headers and footers
11954 specified by the SVF file with HIR, TIR, HDR and TDR commands;
11955 instead, calculate them automatically according to the current JTAG
11956 chain configuration, targeting @var{tapname};
11957 @item @option{-quiet} do not log every command before execution;
11958 @item @option{-nil} ``dry run'', i.e., do not perform any operations
11959 on the real interface;
11960 @item @option{-progress} enable progress indication;
11961 @item @option{-ignore_error} continue execution despite TDO check
11962 errors.
11963 @item @option{-noreset} omit JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) before executing
11964 content of the SVF file;
11965 @item @option{-addcycles @var{cyclecount}} inject @var{cyclecount} number of
11966 additional TCLK cycles after each SDR scan instruction;
11967 @end itemize
11968 @end deffn
11969
11970 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
11971 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
11972 @cindex XSVF
11973
11974 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
11975 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
11976 Xilinx devices.
11977 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
11978 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
11979
11980 @quotation Important
11981 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
11982 @end quotation
11983
11984 @deffn {Command} {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
11985 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
11986 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
11987 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
11988 that TAP.
11989 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
11990 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
11991 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
11992 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
11993 @end deffn
11994
11995 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
11996 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
11997 after building the software.
11998 You may find them useful:
11999
12000 @itemize
12001 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
12002 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
12003 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
12004 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
12005 @end itemize
12006
12007 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
12008 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
12009 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
12010 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
12011 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
12012 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
12013 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
12014
12015
12016 @section IPDBG: JTAG-Host server
12017 @cindex IPDBG JTAG-Host server
12018 @cindex IPDBG
12019
12020 IPDBG is a set of tools to debug IP-Cores. It comprises, among others, a logic analyzer and an arbitrary
12021 waveform generator. These are synthesize-able hardware descriptions of
12022 logic circuits in addition to software for control, visualization and further analysis.
12023 In a session using JTAG for its transport protocol, OpenOCD supports the function
12024 of a JTAG-Host. The JTAG-Host is needed to connect the circuit over JTAG to the
12025 control-software. For more details see @url{http://ipdbg.org}.
12026
12027 @deffn {Command} {ipdbg} [@option{-start|-stop}] @option{-tap @var{tapname}} @option{-hub @var{ir_value} [@var{dr_length}]} [@option{-vir [@var{vir_value} [@var{length} [@var{instr_code}]]]}] [@option{-port @var{number}}] [@option{-tool @var{number}}]
12028 Starts or stops a IPDBG JTAG-Host server. Arguments can be specified in any order.
12029
12030 Command options:
12031 @itemize @bullet
12032 @item @option{-start|-stop} starts or stops a IPDBG JTAG-Host server (default: start).
12033 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} targeting the TAP @var{tapname}.
12034 @item @option{-hub @var{ir_value}} states that the JTAG hub is
12035 reachable with dr-scans while the JTAG instruction register has the value @var{ir_value}.
12036 @item @option{-port @var{number}} tcp port number where the JTAG-Host will listen. The default is 4242 which is used when the option is not given.
12037 @item @option{-tool @var{number}} number of the tool/feature. These corresponds to the ports "data_(up/down)_(0..6)" at the JtagHub. The default is 1 which is used when the option is not given.
12038 @item @option{-vir [@var{vir_value} [@var{length} [@var{instr_code}]]]} On some devices, the user data-register is reachable if there is a
12039 specific value in a second dr. This second dr is called vir (virtual ir). With this parameter given, the IPDBG satisfies this condition prior an
12040 access to the IPDBG-Hub. The value shifted into the vir is given by the first parameter @var{vir_value} (default: 0x11). The second
12041 parameter @var{length} is the length of the vir data register (default: 5). With the @var{instr_code} (default: 0x00e) parameter the ir value to
12042 shift data through vir can be configured.
12043 @end itemize
12044 @end deffn
12045 or
12046 @deffn {Command} {ipdbg} [@option{-start|-stop}] @option{-pld @var{name} [@var{user}]} [@option{-port @var{number}}] [@option{-tool @var{number}}]
12047 Also starts or stops a IPDBG JTAG-Host server. The pld drivers are able to provide the tap and hub/IR for the IPDBG JTAG-Host server.
12048 With the @option{-pld @var{name} [@var{user}]} the information from the pld-driver is used and the options @option{-tap} and @option{-hub} are not required.
12049 The defined driver for the pld @var{name} gets selected. (The pld devices names can be shown by the command @command{pld devices}).
12050
12051 The @verb{|USERx|} instructions are vendor specific and don't change between families of the same vendor.
12052 So if there's a pld driver for your vendor it should work with your FPGA even when the driver is not compatible with your device for the remaining features. If your device/vendor is not supported you have to use the previous command.
12053
12054 With [@var{user}] one can select a different @verb{|USERx|}-Instruction. If the IPDBG JTAG-Hub is used without modification the default value of 1 which selects the first @verb{|USERx|} instruction is adequate.
12055
12056 The remaining options are described in the previous command.
12057 @end deffn
12058
12059 Examples:
12060 @example
12061 ipdbg -start -tap xc6s.tap -hub 0x02 -port 4242 -tool 4
12062 @end example
12063 Starts a server listening on tcp-port 4242 which connects to tool 4.
12064 The connection is through the TAP of a Xilinx Spartan 6 on USER1 instruction (tested with a papillion pro board).
12065
12066 @example
12067 ipdbg -start -tap 10m50.tap -hub 0x00C -vir -port 60000 -tool 1
12068 @end example
12069 Starts a server listening on tcp-port 60000 which connects to tool 1 (data_up_1/data_down_1).
12070 The connection is through the TAP of a Intel MAX10 virtual jtag component (sld_instance_index is 0; sld_ir_width is smaller than 5).
12071
12072 @example
12073 ipdbg -start -pld xc7.pld -port 5555 -tool 0
12074 @end example
12075 Starts a server listening on tcp-port 5555 which connects to tool 0 (data_up_0/data_down_0).
12076 The TAP and ir value used to reach the JTAG Hub is given by the pld driver.
12077
12078
12079 @node Utility Commands
12080 @chapter Utility Commands
12081 @cindex Utility Commands
12082
12083 @section RAM testing
12084 @cindex RAM testing
12085
12086 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
12087 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
12088 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
12089 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
12090 hardware problems.
12091
12092 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
12093 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
12094 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
12095 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
12096
12097 Load the memory testing functions with
12098
12099 @example
12100 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
12101 @end example
12102
12103 to get access to the following facilities:
12104
12105 @deffn {Command} {memTestDataBus} address
12106 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
12107 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
12108 @end deffn
12109
12110 @deffn {Command} {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
12111 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
12112 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
12113 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
12114 @end deffn
12115
12116 @deffn {Command} {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
12117 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
12118 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
12119 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
12120 @end deffn
12121
12122 @deffn {Command} {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
12123 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
12124 @end deffn
12125
12126 @section Firmware recovery helpers
12127 @cindex Firmware recovery
12128
12129 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
12130 devices recovery with JTAG.
12131
12132 For quickstart instructions run:
12133 @example
12134 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
12135 @end example
12136
12137 @node GDB and OpenOCD
12138 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
12139 @cindex GDB
12140 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
12141 to debug remote targets.
12142 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
12143
12144 @itemize
12145 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
12146 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
12147 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
12148 as shown in this chapter.
12149 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
12150 that also will probably need to be configured.
12151 @end itemize
12152
12153 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
12154 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
12155 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
12156 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
12157 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
12158 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
12159
12160 @section Connecting to GDB
12161 @cindex Connecting to GDB
12162 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
12163 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
12164 errors, which has since been fixed; see
12165 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
12166
12167 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
12168
12169 @enumerate
12170 @item
12171 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
12172 @example
12173 target extended-remote localhost:3333
12174 @end example
12175 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
12176
12177 The extended remote protocol is a super-set of the remote protocol and should
12178 be the preferred choice. More details are available in GDB documentation
12179 @url{https://sourceware.org/gdb/onlinedocs/gdb/Connecting.html}
12180
12181 To speed-up typing, any GDB command can be abbreviated, including the extended
12182 remote command above that becomes:
12183 @example
12184 tar ext :3333
12185 @end example
12186
12187 @b{Note:} If any backward compatibility issue requires using the old remote
12188 protocol in place of the extended remote one, the former protocol is still
12189 available through the command:
12190 @example
12191 target remote localhost:3333
12192 @end example
12193
12194 @item
12195 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
12196 @example
12197 target extended-remote | \
12198 openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
12199 @end example
12200 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
12201 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
12202 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
12203 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
12204 @end enumerate
12205
12206 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
12207 GDB command line.
12208
12209 @section Sample GDB session startup
12210
12211 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
12212 than they do when you're debugging locally.
12213 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
12214 small ARM program.
12215 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
12216 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
12217
12218 @example
12219 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
12220 (gdb) target extended-remote localhost:3333
12221 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
12222 ...
12223 (gdb) monitor reset halt
12224 ...
12225 (gdb) load
12226 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
12227 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
12228 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
12229 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
12230 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
12231 (gdb) continue
12232 Continuing.
12233 ...
12234 @end example
12235
12236 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
12237 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
12238 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
12239 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
12240
12241 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
12242
12243 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
12244 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
12245 packet size and the device's memory map.
12246 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
12247 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
12248 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
12249
12250 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
12251 You may need to set those up by hand.
12252 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
12253 something like:
12254
12255 @example
12256 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
12257 @end example
12258
12259 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
12260
12261 @example
12262 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
12263 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
12264 @end example
12265
12266 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
12267 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
12268 do not have such restrictions.
12269
12270 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
12271 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
12272 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
12273 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
12274
12275 @section Programming using GDB
12276 @cindex Programming using GDB
12277 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
12278
12279 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
12280 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
12281 @example
12282 gdb_memory_map disable
12283 @end example
12284 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
12285 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
12286 working area.
12287
12288 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
12289 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
12290 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
12291 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
12292
12293 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
12294 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
12295
12296 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
12297 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
12298 @example
12299 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
12300 @end example
12301
12302 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
12303 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
12304
12305 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
12306 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
12307 will be used.
12308
12309 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, set target
12310 event gdb-flash-erase-start:
12311 @example
12312 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-flash-erase-start BODY
12313 @end example
12314 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, for other GDB programming related events.
12315
12316 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
12317 can be used.
12318
12319 @section Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
12320 @cindex Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
12321 @anchor{gdbmeminspect}
12322
12323 If your project controls more than a blinking LED, let's say a heavy industrial
12324 robot or an experimental nuclear reactor, stopping the controlling process
12325 just because you want to attach GDB is not a good option.
12326
12327 OpenOCD does not support GDB non-stop mode (might be implemented in the future).
12328 Though there is a possible setup where the target does not get stopped
12329 and GDB treats it as it were running.
12330 If the target supports background access to memory while it is running,
12331 you can use GDB in this mode to inspect memory (mainly global variables)
12332 without any intrusion of the target process.
12333
12334 Remove default setting of gdb-attach event. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
12335 Place following command after target configuration:
12336 @example
12337 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-attach @{@}
12338 @end example
12339
12340 If any of installed flash banks does not support probe on running target,
12341 switch off gdb_memory_map:
12342 @example
12343 gdb_memory_map disable
12344 @end example
12345
12346 Ensure GDB is configured without interrupt-on-connect.
12347 Some GDB versions set it by default, some does not.
12348 @example
12349 set remote interrupt-on-connect off
12350 @end example
12351
12352 If you switched gdb_memory_map off, you may want to setup GDB memory map
12353 manually or issue @command{set mem inaccessible-by-default off}
12354
12355 Now you can issue GDB command @command{target extended-remote ...} and inspect memory
12356 of a running target. Do not use GDB commands @command{continue},
12357 @command{step} or @command{next} as they synchronize GDB with your target
12358 and GDB would require stopping the target to get the prompt back.
12359
12360 Do not use this mode under an IDE like Eclipse as it caches values of
12361 previously shown variables.
12362
12363 It's also possible to connect more than one GDB to the same target by the
12364 target's configuration option @code{-gdb-max-connections}. This allows, for
12365 example, one GDB to run a script that continuously polls a set of variables
12366 while other GDB can be used interactively. Be extremely careful in this case,
12367 because the two GDB can easily get out-of-sync.
12368
12369 @section RTOS Support
12370 @cindex RTOS Support
12371 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
12372
12373 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
12374 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target. @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
12375
12376 @xref{Threads, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads,
12377 Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads, gdb, GDB manual}, for details about relevant
12378 GDB commands.
12379
12380 @* An example setup is below:
12381
12382 @example
12383 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
12384 @end example
12385
12386 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
12387
12388 Currently supported rtos's include:
12389 @itemize @bullet
12390 @item @option{eCos}
12391 @item @option{ThreadX}
12392 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
12393 @item @option{linux}
12394 @item @option{ChibiOS}
12395 @item @option{embKernel}
12396 @item @option{mqx}
12397 @item @option{uCOS-III}
12398 @item @option{nuttx}
12399 @item @option{RIOT}
12400 @item @option{hwthread} (This is not an actual RTOS. @xref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.)
12401 @item @option{Zephyr}
12402 @item @option{rtkernel}
12403 @end itemize
12404
12405 At any time, it's possible to drop the selected RTOS using:
12406 @example
12407 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos none
12408 @end example
12409
12410 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
12411 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
12412
12413 @table @code
12414 @item eCos symbols
12415 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
12416 @item ThreadX symbols
12417 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
12418 @item FreeRTOS symbols
12419 @raggedright
12420 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
12421 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
12422 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority, xSchedulerRunning.
12423 @end raggedright
12424 @item linux symbols
12425 init_task.
12426 @item ChibiOS symbols
12427 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
12428 @item embKernel symbols
12429 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
12430 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
12431 @item mqx symbols
12432 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
12433 @item uC/OS-III symbols
12434 OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty.
12435 @item nuttx symbols
12436 g_readytorun, g_tasklisttable.
12437 @item RIOT symbols
12438 @raggedright
12439 sched_threads, sched_num_threads, sched_active_pid, max_threads,
12440 _tcb_name_offset.
12441 @end raggedright
12442 @item Zephyr symbols
12443 _kernel, _kernel_openocd_offsets, _kernel_openocd_size_t_size
12444 @item rtkernel symbols
12445 Multiple struct offsets.
12446 @end table
12447
12448 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
12449 some, eg. FreeRTOS, uC/OS-III and Zephyr, extra steps must be taken.
12450
12451 Zephyr must be compiled with the DEBUG_THREAD_INFO option. This will generate some symbols
12452 with information needed in order to build the list of threads.
12453
12454 FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
12455 along with the project:
12456
12457 @table @code
12458 @item FreeRTOS
12459 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
12460 @item uC/OS-III
12461 contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
12462 @end table
12463
12464 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
12465 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
12466 @cindex SMP
12467 @cindex RTOS
12468 @cindex hwthread
12469 OpenOCD includes a pseudo RTOS called @emph{hwthread} that presents CPU cores
12470 ("hardware threads") in an SMP system as threads to GDB. With this extension,
12471 GDB can be used to inspect the state of an SMP system in a natural way.
12472 After halting the system, using the GDB command @command{info threads} will
12473 list the context of each active CPU core in the system. GDB's @command{thread}
12474 command can be used to switch the view to a different CPU core.
12475 The @command{step} and @command{stepi} commands can be used to step a specific core
12476 while other cores are free-running or remain halted, depending on the
12477 scheduler-locking mode configured in GDB.
12478
12479 @node Tcl Scripting API
12480 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
12481 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
12482 @cindex Tcl scripts
12483 @section API rules
12484
12485 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
12486 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
12487 of state information as an argument to each proc.
12488
12489 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
12490 pair list and lists.
12491
12492 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
12493 list.
12494
12495 @example
12496 > set foo(me) Duane
12497 > set foo(you) Oyvind
12498 > set foo(mouse) Micky
12499 > set foo(duck) Donald
12500 @end example
12501
12502 If one does this:
12503
12504 @example
12505 > set foo
12506 @end example
12507
12508 The result is:
12509
12510 @example
12511 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
12512 @end example
12513
12514 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
12515
12516 @verbatim
12517 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
12518 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
12519 }
12520 @end verbatim
12521
12522 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
12523 should be passed in to the proc in question.
12524
12525 @section Internal low-level Commands
12526
12527 By "low-level", we mean commands that a human would typically not
12528 invoke directly.
12529
12530 @itemize
12531 @item @b{flash banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
12532
12533 Return information about the flash banks
12534
12535 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
12536
12537 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
12538 its execution together with the command output. Example:
12539
12540 @example
12541 > capture "reset init"
12542 @end example
12543
12544 @end itemize
12545
12546 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
12547 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
12548 called "flash_banks".
12549
12550 @section Tcl RPC server
12551 @cindex RPC
12552
12553 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
12554 commands and receive the results.
12555
12556 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
12557 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
12558 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
12559 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
12560 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
12561
12562 It is not needed anymore to prefix the OpenOCD commands with
12563 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. But sometimes you might need the
12564 @command{capture} command.
12565
12566 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
12567
12568 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
12569 @cindex RPC Notifications
12570
12571 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
12572 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
12573
12574 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
12575 in the following format.
12576
12577 @verbatim
12578 type target_event event [event-name]
12579 type target_state state [state-name]
12580 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
12581 @end verbatim
12582
12583 @deffn {Command} {tcl_notifications} [on/off]
12584 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
12585 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
12586 Defaults to off.
12587
12588 @end deffn
12589
12590 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
12591 @cindex RPC trace output
12592
12593 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
12594 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
12595
12596 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
12597
12598 @verbatim
12599 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
12600 @end verbatim
12601
12602 @deffn {Command} {tcl_trace} [on/off]
12603 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
12604 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
12605 Defaults to off.
12606
12607 See an example application here:
12608 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
12609
12610 @end deffn
12611
12612 @node FAQ
12613 @chapter FAQ
12614 @cindex faq
12615 @enumerate
12616 @anchor{faqrtck}
12617 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
12618 @cindex RTCK
12619 @cindex adaptive clocking
12620 @*
12621
12622 In digital circuit design it is often referred to as ``clock
12623 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
12624 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
12625 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
12626
12627 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
12628 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
12629 for example. There are 2 basic options:
12630 @enumerate
12631 @item
12632 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
12633 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
12634 @item
12635 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
12636 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
12637 @end enumerate
12638
12639 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
12640 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
12641 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
12642 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
12643 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
12644 power).
12645
12646 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
12647 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
12648 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
12649 ARM926 scenario).
12650 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
12651 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
12652 JTAG can use a faster clock.
12653
12654 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
12655 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
12656 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
12657 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
12658
12659 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
12660
12661 In order to make use of this,
12662 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
12663 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
12664
12665 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
12666 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
12667 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
12668 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
12669 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
12670
12671 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
12672 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
12673 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
12674 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
12675
12676 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
12677 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
12678 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
12679 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
12680 with a CPLD.
12681 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
12682 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
12683 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
12684 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
12685 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
12686 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
12687
12688 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
12689
12690 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
12691
12692 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
12693 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
12694 depending on the chips on your board.
12695 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
12696 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
12697 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
12698
12699 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
12700 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
12701 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
12702
12703 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
12704 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
12705 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
12706 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
12707
12708 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
12709 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
12710 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
12711 this way.
12712
12713 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
12714 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
12715 clock rate.
12716 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
12717 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
12718 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
12719
12720 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
12721
12722 @example
12723 # Example: 1.234MHz
12724 adapter speed 1234
12725 @end example
12726
12727
12728 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
12729
12730 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
12731 around Windows filenames.
12732
12733 @example
12734 > echo \a
12735
12736 > echo @{\a@}
12737 \a
12738 > echo "\a"
12739
12740 >
12741 @end example
12742
12743
12744 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
12745
12746 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
12747 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
12748 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
12749
12750 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a front-end like Insight or
12751 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
12752 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
12753
12754 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
12755 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
12756 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
12757
12758 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
12759
12760 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
12761 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
12762 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
12763 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
12764
12765 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
12766 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
12767 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
12768
12769 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
12770 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
12771
12772 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
12773 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
12774 memory read caused data abort".
12775
12776 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
12777 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
12778 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
12779 be done, feel free to add this here.
12780
12781 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
12782 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
12783 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
12784 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
12785 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
12786 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
12787 gracefully stops.
12788
12789 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
12790 your C code, do the same - artificially push some zeros onto the stack,
12791 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
12792
12793 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
12794 often do not @b{in the interest of saving memory} waste these few
12795 bytes. Painful...
12796
12797
12798 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
12799 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
12800
12801 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
12802 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{reset_config
12803 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
12804 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
12805 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
12806 reset, everything else should work fine.
12807
12808 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
12809 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
12810 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
12811 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
12812
12813 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
12814 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
12815 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
12816 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
12817
12818 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
12819
12820 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
12821 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
12822 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
12823
12824 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
12825 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
12826
12827 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
12828 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
12829 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
12830 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
12831 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
12832 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
12833 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
12834 clock frequency?
12835
12836 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
12837 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
12838 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
12839 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
12840 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
12841
12842 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
12843
12844 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
12845 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
12846 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
12847 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
12848 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
12849 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
12850 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
12851
12852 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
12853
12854 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
12855 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
12856 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
12857 up DRAM and loading it with code.
12858
12859 @anchor{faqtaporder}
12860 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
12861 particular order?
12862
12863 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
12864 the same order used by the hardware.
12865
12866 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example:
12867 STMicroelectronics STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
12868 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
12869 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
12870 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
12871 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
12872
12873 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
12874 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
12875 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
12876 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
12877
12878 @itemize @bullet
12879 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
12880 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
12881 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
12882 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
12883 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
12884 @end itemize
12885
12886 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
12887
12888 @itemize @bullet
12889 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
12890 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
12891 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
12892 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
12893 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
12894 @end itemize
12895
12896
12897 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
12898 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
12899 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
12900
12901 TODO.
12902
12903 @end enumerate
12904
12905 @node Tcl Crash Course
12906 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
12907 @cindex Tcl
12908
12909 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
12910 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
12911 how the Tcl scripts work.
12912
12913 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
12914 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
12915 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
12916 OpenOCD.
12917
12918 @section Tcl Rule #1
12919 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
12920 @enumerate
12921 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
12922 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
12923 @end enumerate
12924
12925 The Tcl equal is this:
12926
12927 @enumerate
12928 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
12929 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
12930 @end enumerate
12931
12932 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
12933 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
12934
12935 @section Tcl Rule #1b
12936 There is a second pair of rules.
12937 @enumerate
12938 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
12939 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
12940 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
12941 in Tcl.
12942 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
12943 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
12944 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
12945 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
12946 @end enumerate
12947
12948 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
12949 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
12950 deliberately. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
12951 Everything is a string}
12952
12953 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
12954 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
12955 difference is subtle.
12956 @enumerate
12957 @item Parse Time
12958 @item Evaluation Time
12959 @end enumerate
12960
12961 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
12962 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
12963 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
12964
12965 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
12966 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
12967 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC language ``let x
12968 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
12969
12970 @itemize @bullet
12971 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
12972 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
12973 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
12974 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
12975 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
12976 @example
12977 # bash example
12978 X=`date`
12979 echo "The Date is: $X"
12980 # Tcl example
12981 set X [date]
12982 puts "The Date is: $X"
12983 @end example
12984 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
12985 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
12986 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
12987 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
12988 is a string}
12989 @example
12990 set x "Dinner"
12991 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
12992 @end example
12993 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
12994 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
12995 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
12996 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
12997 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
12998 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
12999 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
13000 @end itemize
13001
13002 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
13003
13004 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
13005
13006 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
13007
13008 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
13009 the normal way.
13010
13011 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
13012 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
13013 line is immediately executed.
13014
13015 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
13016 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
13017
13018 @subsection Command Execution
13019
13020 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
13021 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
13022 control flow operators.
13023
13024 Commands are executed like this:
13025
13026 @enumerate
13027 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
13028 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
13029 @item Repeat until End Of File.
13030 @end enumerate
13031
13032 It sort of works like this:
13033 @example
13034 for(;;)@{
13035 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
13036
13037 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
13038
13039 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
13040 @}
13041 @end example
13042
13043 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
13044 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
13045 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
13046 of the function. Note the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
13047 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
13048 ``LookupCommand()''
13049
13050 @subsection The FOR command
13051
13052 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
13053 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
13054 command just like any other command.
13055
13056 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
13057 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
13058 are:
13059
13060 @enumerate 0
13061 @item The ascii text 'for'
13062 @item The start text
13063 @item The test expression
13064 @item The next text
13065 @item The body text
13066 @end enumerate
13067
13068 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
13069 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
13070 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
13071 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
13072
13073 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
13074 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
13075
13076 @example
13077 int
13078 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
13079 int *argc,
13080 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
13081 @end example
13082
13083 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
13084 introduced a byte-code parser and interpreter, but at the core, it
13085 still operates in the same basic way.
13086
13087 @subsection FOR command implementation
13088
13089 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
13090 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
13091
13092 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
13093
13094 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
13095
13096 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
13097 string. Commands can be separated by semicolons, or newlines. While
13098 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
13099
13100 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
13101 expression and returns a value.
13102
13103 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
13104 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
13105 @example
13106 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
13107
13108 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
13109
13110 int
13111 MyForCommand( void *interp,
13112 int argc,
13113 char **argv )
13114 @{
13115 if( argc != 5 )@{
13116 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
13117 return ERROR;
13118 @}
13119
13120 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
13121
13122 // Execute the start statement.
13123 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
13124
13125 // Top of loop test
13126 for(;;)@{
13127 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
13128 if( i == 0 )
13129 break;
13130
13131 // Execute the body
13132 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
13133
13134 // Execute the LOOP part
13135 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
13136 @}
13137
13138 // Return no error
13139 SetResult( interp, "" );
13140 return SUCCESS;
13141 @}
13142 @end example
13143
13144 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
13145 in the same basic way.
13146
13147 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
13148
13149 @subsection source and find commands
13150 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
13151 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
13152 @*Remember the parsing rules
13153 @enumerate
13154 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
13155 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
13156 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
13157 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
13158 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
13159 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
13160 That character begins Tcl comments.)
13161 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
13162 it reads a file and executes as a script.
13163 @end enumerate
13164 @subsection format command
13165 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
13166 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
13167 @b{sprintf()}.
13168 @b{Example}
13169 @example
13170 set x 6
13171 set y 7
13172 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr @{$x * $y@}]]
13173 @end example
13174 @enumerate
13175 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
13176 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
13177 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
13178 @* Refer to Rule #1
13179 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
13180 @* Refer to Rule #1.
13181 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
13182 @end enumerate
13183 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
13184 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
13185 @example
13186 #1 Good
13187 proc someproc @{@} @{
13188 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
13189 @}
13190 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
13191 #2 Good - no variables
13192 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "this ; that;"
13193 #3 Good Curly Braces
13194 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
13195 puts "Time: [date]"
13196 @}
13197 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
13198 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
13199 @end example
13200 @enumerate
13201 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
13202 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
13203 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
13204 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
13205 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
13206 command.
13207 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
13208 @*There are 4 examples:
13209 @enumerate
13210 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
13211 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands separated by semicolons
13212 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
13213 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
13214 @end enumerate
13215
13216 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
13217 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
13218 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
13219
13220 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
13221 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
13222 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
13223 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
13224 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
13225 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
13226 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
13227 @end enumerate
13228 @subsection Global Variables
13229 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
13230 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
13231 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
13232 @example
13233 proc myproc @{ @} @{
13234 set y 0 #Local variable Y
13235 global x #Global variable X
13236 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
13237 @}
13238 @end example
13239 @section Other Tcl Hacks
13240 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
13241 @example
13242 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
13243 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr @{$x + 1@}]@} @{
13244 # Create var name
13245 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
13246 # Make it a global
13247 global $vn
13248 # Set it.
13249 set $vn [expr @{1 << $x@}]
13250 @}
13251 @end example
13252 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
13253 @example
13254 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
13255 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
13256 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
13257 @}
13258 @end example
13259
13260 @node License
13261 @appendix The GNU Free Documentation License.
13262 @include fdl.texi
13263
13264 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
13265 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
13266 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
13267 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
13268 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
13269 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
13270
13271 @printindex cp
13272
13273 @node Command and Driver Index
13274 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
13275 @printindex fn
13276
13277 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)